UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

 

 

 

 

 

Form 10-K

 

 

 

(Mark One)

R

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

 

 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011

 

 

 

or

 

 

o

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

 

 

For the transition period from              to                 

 

Commission File Number: 001-11919

 

 

 

 

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc.

(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Delaware

 

84-1291044

(State or other jurisdiction of

 

(I.R.S. Employer

incorporation or organization)

 

Identification No.)

 

9197 South Peoria Street

Englewood, Colorado 80112

(Address of principal executive offices)

 

Registrant’s telephone number, including area code:

(303) 397-8100

 

 

 

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of each class

 

Name of each exchange on which registered

Common Stock, $0.01 par value

 

NASDAQ Global Select Market

 

Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:  None.

 

Indicate by checkmark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.

Yes o No R

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Yes o No R

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports) and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes R No o

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).

YesR   No o

 

Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K (§ 229.405) is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of this Form 10-K or any amendment to this Form 10-K.  R

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

 

Large accelerated filer  o

 

Accelerated filer R

 

 

 

Non-accelerated filer o  (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)

 

Smaller reporting company o

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).  Yes o No R

 

As of June 30, 2011, the last business day of the registrant’s most recently completed second fiscal quarter, there were 56,615,262 shares of the registrant’s common stock outstanding. The aggregate market value of the registrant’s voting and non-voting common stock that was held by non-affiliates on such date was $528,201,476 based on the closing sale price of the registrant’s common stock on such date as reported on the NASDAQ Global Select Market.

 

As of February 23, 2012, there were 56,615,002 shares of the registrant’s common stock outstanding.

 

DOCUMENTS INCORPORATED BY REFERENCE

 

Certain information required for Part III of this report is incorporated by reference to the proxy statement for the registrant’s 2012 annual meeting of stockholders.

 



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

DECEMBER 31, 2011 FORM 10-K

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

 

Page No.

 

 

CAUTIONARY NOTE ABOUT FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

ii

 

 

PART I

 

 

 

 

 

Item 1.

Business

1

 

 

 

Item 1A.

Risk Factors

9

 

 

 

Item 1B.

Unresolved Staff Comments

20

 

 

 

Item 2.

Properties

20

 

 

 

Item 3.

Legal Proceedings

21

 

 

 

Item 4.

Mine Safety Disclosures

21

 

 

 

PART II.

 

 

 

 

 

Item 5.

Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

21

 

 

 

Item 6.

Selected Financial Data

24

 

 

 

Item 7.

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations

25

 

 

 

Item 7A.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk

48

 

 

 

Item 8.

Financial Statements and Supplementary Data

51

 

 

 

Item 9.

Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure

51

 

 

 

Item 9A.

Controls and Procedures

51

 

 

 

Item 9B.

Other Information

52

 

 

 

PART III

 

 

 

 

 

Item 10.

Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance

52

 

 

 

Item 11.

Executive Compensation

52

 

 

 

Item 12.

Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters

53

 

 

 

Item 13.

Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence

53

 

 

 

Item 14.

Principal Accountants Fees and Services

53

 

 

 

PART IV

 

 

 

 

 

Item 15.

Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules

53

 

 

 

SIGNATURES

57

 

 

INDEX TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.

F-1

 

i



 

NON-GAAP FINANCIAL MEASURES

 

In various places throughout this Annual Report on Form 10-K (“Form 10-K”), we use certain financial measures to describe our performance that are not accepted measures under accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (non-GAAP financial measures). We believe such non-GAAP financial measures are informative to the users of our financial information because we use these measures to manage our business. We discuss non-GAAP financial measures in Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations of this Form 10-K under the heading Presentation of Non-GAAP Measurements.

 

CAUTIONARY NOTE ABOUT FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

 

This Form 10-K and the information incorporated by reference contains “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of Section 27A of the Securities Act of 1933 and Section 21E of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 (the “PSLRA”) or in releases made by the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”), all as may be amended from time to time. In particular, we direct your attention to Item 1. Business, Item 3. Legal Proceedings, Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk and Item 9A. Controls and Procedures. We intend the forward-looking statements throughout this Form 10-K and the information incorporated by reference to be covered by the safe harbor provisions for forward-looking statements. All projections and statements regarding our expected financial position and operating results, our business strategy, our financing plans and the outcome of any contingencies are forward-looking statements. These statements can sometimes be identified by our use of forward-looking words such as “may,” “believe,” “plan,” “will,” “anticipate,” “estimate,” “expect,” “intend,” “project,” “would,” “could,” “should,” “seeks,” or “scheduled to” and other words and phrases of similar meaning. Known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors could cause the actual results to differ materially from those contemplated by the statements. The forward-looking information is based on information available as of the date of this Form 10-K and on numerous assumptions and developments that are not within our control. Although we believe these forward-looking statements are reasonable, we cannot assure you they will turn out to be correct. Actual results could be materially different from our expectations due to a variety of factors, including, but not limited to, the factors identified in this Form 10-K under the captions Item 1A. Risk Factors and Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, our other SEC filings and our press releases. We assume no obligation to update: (i) forward-looking statements to reflect actual results or (ii) changes in factors affecting such forward-looking statements.

 

AVAILABILITY OF INFORMATION

 

You may read and copy any materials TeleTech files with the SEC at the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F. Street, N.E., Room 1580, Washington, D.C. 20549. Copies of such materials also can be obtained at the SEC’s website, www.sec.gov or by mail from the Public Reference Room of the SEC, at the proscribed rates.  Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on the Public Reference Room. TeleTech’s SEC filings are also available to the public, free of charge, on its corporate website, www.teletech.com, as soon as reasonably practicable after TeleTech electronically files such material with, or furnishes it to, the SEC.

 

ii



 

PART I

 

ITEM 1.  BUSINESS

 

Our Business

 

Over our 30-year history, we have become one of the largest global providers of customer experience strategy, technology and business process outsourcing (“BPO”) solutions. We help our clients design, build, implement and manage superior customer experiences across the customer lifecycle in order to maximize revenue, increase brand loyalty and optimize business profitability.

 

Our fully integrated suite of technology-enabled customer-centric services span:

 

·      Professional Services. Leveraging our proprietary, data-driven methodology, our team of management consultants partner with clients to build the business case and design the roadmap for implementing a customer-centric business strategy. We utilize highly sophisticated customer analytics to create technology-enabled, multi-channel interaction strategies to optimize and personalize the customer experience, increase brand loyalty and help clients achieve their business and financial objectives.

 

·      Revenue Generation. Through our data-driven sales and marketing capabilities we help our clients improve revenue and profitability by targeting new or underpenetrated markets and maximizing the revenue potential of each customer. We deliver more than $1 billion in annual revenue for our clients via more than 700 TeleTech-designed and managed client-branded e-commerce websites. We also process more than three terabytes of customer data daily to create and implement sophisticated customer targeting and segmentation strategies to maximize customer acquisition, retention and growth.

 

·      Customer Innovation Solutions. We redesign and manage clients’ front-office processes to deliver just-in-time, personalized, multi-channel customer experiences. Leveraging our highly trained customer experience professionals within our onshore and offshore delivery centers as well as our TeleTech@Home work-from-home agents, our solutions integrate voice, chat, e-mail, ecommerce and social media to optimize the customer experience for our clients.

 

·      Enterprise Innovation Solutions. We redesign and manage clients’ back-office processes, such as administration, finance, accounting, logistics and distribution, to significantly advance clients’ abilities to obtain a customer-centric view of their relationships, and maximize operating efficiencies. Our delivery of integrated business processes via on our onshore, offshore or work-from-home customer experience professionals reduces operating costs and allows customer needs to be met more quickly and efficiently, resulting in higher customer satisfaction and brand loyalty and an improved competitive position.

 

·      Managed Technology Solutions. We offer software and infrastructure as a service on a fully hosted basis. In addition, we provide the design, implementation and ongoing management of clients’ premise-based delivery center environments to enable companies to deliver a superior customer experience across all touch points on a global scale with higher quality, lower costs and reduced risk.

 

·      Learning Innovation Training Solutions. We offer workforce training services via a blended methodology which includes virtual job-simulation environments, eLearning courses, interactive social media networking and collaboration, as well as intuitive 3D and game-based learning courses to increase speed to proficiency, improve employee engagement and retention while also lowering training expenses.

 

·      Data Analytics. We offer and underpin all of the above solutions with a robust data analytics capability to provide real time and actionable customer insight regarding how to grow revenue, reduce customer churn, and maximize operating efficiencies.

 

1



 

We support more than 450 unique programs for approximately 175 global clients, many of whom are in the Global 1000, which are the world’s largest companies based on market capitalization. As of December 31, 2011, our approximately 42,300 employees provided services across 24 countries from 58 customer experience delivery centers and work-from-home environments for governments and private sector clients in the automotive, broadband, cable, financial services, healthcare, logistics, media and entertainment, retail, technology, travel, and wireline and wireless communication industries.

 

We were founded in 1982 and reorganized as a Delaware corporation in 1994. We completed an initial public offering of our common stock in 1996 and since that time have grown our annual revenue from $183 million to $1.2 billion, representing a compound annual growth rate (“CAGR”) of 13.2%.

 

In 2011, our revenue increased 7.7% to $1.2 billion from $1.1 billion in 2010 as a result of a net increase in existing client programs, the addition of 41 new clients and the acquisitions of both the Peppers & Rogers Group and eLoyalty Corporation. Our revenue is reported in our North American and International BPO segments. Certain information with respect to segments and geographic areas is contained in Note 3 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

As of December 31, 2011, we had $156.4 million in cash and cash equivalents and a debt to capitalization ratio of 12.4%. We generated $75.5 million in free cash flow during 2011 and our cash flows from operations and borrowings under our revolving credit facility have enabled us to fund $38.7 million in capital expenditures and $63.7 million in stock repurchases. Approximately 60% of our capital expenditures were related to the opening and/or growth of our customer experience delivery platform with the remaining 40% used for maintenance of our embedded infrastructure and internal technology projects. See Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations for discussion of free cash flow.

 

The Company has a stock repurchase program which was initially authorized by the Company’s Board of Directors (the “Board”) in November 2001. The Board periodically authorizes additional increases to the program. As of December 31, 2011, the cumulative authorized repurchase allowance was $462.3 million, of which we have purchased 32.2 million shares for $430.6 million. As of December 31, 2011, the remaining allowance under the program was approximately $31.7 million. For the period from January 1, 2012 through February 23, 2012, we have purchased an additional 0.2 million shares for $2.4 million. The stock repurchase program does not have an expiration date.

 

Our Market Opportunity

 

We market our customer experience solutions primarily to Global 1000 clients in G-20 countries which represent 19 of the world’s largest economies, together with the European Union, and perform the majority of our services from strategically located customer experience delivery centers around the globe. Many of our clients choose a blended strategy whereby they outsource work with us in multiple geographic locations and may also utilize our work-from-home offering. We believe our ability to offer one of the most geographically diverse footprints improves service flexibility while reducing operational and delivery risk in the event of a service interruption at any one location.

 

Our solutions are designed to address the rapidly changing profile of the customer. Digital interactions, including text, web, chat, self-service and social media, are increasingly outpacing the volume of voice and email transactions. While 90% of customer inquiries were handled by phone or email just five years ago, today more than 50% of inquiries are coming through self-help and community channels. At the same time, customer expectations are also rising. A recent survey showed that 75% of consumers expect a response from a company online within one hour.

 

We believe these trends are placing the customer experience at the forefront of business leaders’ agendas as a critical path to growth and differentiation and driving increased demand for our solutions. Our technology-enabled solutions seamlessly integrate mobile devices, self-service and human-assisted channels while embedding data-driven customer insights to optimize and personalize the customer experience for our clients.

 

2



 

Industry studies indicate that companies with high quality customer experience levels tend to grow faster and more profitably and typically enjoy premium pricing and market valuations in their industry. Given this strong correlation between customer satisfaction and improved profitability, we believe that more companies are increasingly focused on selecting partners, such as TeleTech, that can deliver strategic solutions across a continuum of capabilities that are designed to grow revenue and optimize the customer experience versus merely reduce costs.

 

We believe that our revenue will grow over the long-term as global demand for our services is fueled by the following trends:

 

·      Increased focus on the customer experience. Given the strong correlation between customer satisfaction and improved profitability, we believe that more companies are increasingly focused on selecting outsourcing partners, such as TeleTech, that can deliver strategic solutions across a continuum of capabilities that are designed to grow revenue and optimize the customer experience versus merely reduce costs.

 

·      Focus on partners who can offer multi-channel, technology-rich customer experience solutions. The rapidly changing profile of the customer and rising customer expectations are driving increased demand for personalized and seamlessly integrated multi-channel solutions that incorporate mobile devices, self-service and human-assisted channels while embedding data-driven customer insights.

 

·      Focus on partners who can offer fully integrated revenue generation solutions. A focus on partners who can offer fully integrated revenue generation solutions to maximize the revenue and profitability potential of each customer, improve customer acquisition, retention and growth and target new or underpenetrated markets.

 

·      Integration of front- and back-office business processes to provide increased operating efficiencies and an enhanced customer experience especially in light of the weakening global economic environment. Companies have realized that integrated business processes reduce operating costs and allow customer needs to be met more quickly and efficiently resulting in higher customer satisfaction and brand loyalty thereby improving their competitive position. A majority of our historic revenue has been derived from providing customer-facing front-office solutions to our clients. Given that our global delivery centers are also fully capable of providing back-office solutions, we are uniquely positioned to grow our revenue by winning more back-office opportunities and providing the services during non-peak hours with minimal incremental investment. Furthermore, by spreading our fixed costs across a larger revenue base and increasing our asset utilization, we expect our profitability to improve over time.

 

·      Increasing percentage of company operations being outsourced to most capable third-party partners. Having experienced success with outsourcing a portion of their business processes, companies are increasingly inclined to outsource a larger percentage of this work. We believe companies will continue to consolidate their business processes with third-party partners, such as TeleTech, who are financially stable and able to invest in their business while also demonstrating an extensive global operating history and an ability to cost effectively scale to meet their evolving needs.

 

·      Increasing adoption of outsourcing across broader groups of industries. Early adopters of the business process outsourcing trend, such as the media and communications industries, are being joined by companies in other industries, including healthcare, retail and financial services. These companies are beginning to adopt outsourcing to improve their business processes and competitiveness. For example, we see increasing interest in our services from companies in the healthcare, retail and financial services industries. We believe the number of other industries that will adopt or increase their level of outsourcing will continue to grow, further enabling us to increase and diversify our revenue and client base.

 

3



 

·      Focus on speed-to-market by companies launching new products or entering new geographic locations. As companies broaden their product offerings and seek to enter new emerging markets, they are looking for outsourcing partners that can provide speed-to-market while reducing their capital and operating risk. To achieve these benefits, companies are seeking BPO partners with an extensive operating history, an established global footprint, the financial strength to invest in innovation to deliver more strategic capabilities and the ability to scale and meet customer demands quickly. Given our financial stability, geographic presence in 24 countries and our significant investment in standardized technology and processes, we believe that clients select TeleTech because we can quickly ramp large, complex business processes around the globe in a short period of time while assuring a high-quality experience for their customers.

 

Our Competitive Strengths

 

Entering a business services outsourcing relationship is typically a long-term strategic commitment for companies. The outsourced processes are usually complex and require a high degree of customization and integration with a client’s core operations. Accordingly, our clients tend to enter long-term contracts which provide us with a more predictable revenue stream. In addition, for many of our clients we provide services for multiple of their unique programs across their many lines of business. We do provide certain client programs on a short-term basis. We have high levels of client retention due to our operational excellence and ability to meet our clients’ customer experience management objectives, as well as the significant transition costs required by our client to exit the relationship. Our client retention was 95% in 2011 and 90% in 2010, excluding the completion of the short-term government programs.

 

We believe that our clients select us due to our:

 

·      End-to-end suite of customer experience solutions, spanning strategic professional consulting, revenue generation, front and back office business process outsourcing, fully-hosted or managed technology and learning innovation services.

 

·      Ability to deliver multi-channel, technology-rich customer experience solutions to meet the demands of the rapidly changing profile of the customer and rising customer expectations.

 

·      Industry reputation and our position as one of the largest and most financially sound industry partners with 30 years of expertise in delivering complex customer experience management across targeted industries;

 

·      Ability to scale infrastructure and employees worldwide using globally deployed best practices to ensure a consistent, high-quality service;

 

·      Ability to optimize the performance of our workforce through proprietary hiring, training and performance optimization tools; and

 

·      Commitment to continued product and services innovation to further diversify our revenue and enhance the strategic capabilities of our clients.

 

As the complexity and technology required to deliver an exceptional customer experience increases, we continue to develop other innovative services that leverage our investment in a centralized and standardized delivery platform to meet our clients’ needs, and we believe that these solutions will represent a growing percentage of our future revenue.

 

These investments include our 2010 acquisition of a majority interest in Peppers & Rogers Group to further enhance our professional services capabilities and our 2011 acquisition of eLoyalty to enhance our systems integration and telephony and technology offerings. In addition, we have begun to offer cloud-based ‘hosted services’ where clients can license any aspect of our global network and proprietary applications. While the revenue from these offerings is small relative to our consolidated revenue, we believe it will continue to grow as these services become more widely adopted by our clients. We aim to further improve our competitive position by investing in a growing suite of new and innovative customer experience solutions across our targeted industries.

 

4



 

We believe that technological innovation, best operating practices and innovative human capital strategies that can scale globally are key elements to our continued industry leadership.

 

Technological Innovation

 

We have measurably transformed our technology platform by moving to a secure, private, 100% internet protocol (“IP”) based infrastructure. This transformation has enabled us to centralize and standardize our worldwide delivery capabilities resulting in improved quality of delivery for our clients along with lower capital and information technology (“IT”) operating costs.

 

The foundation of this platform is our four IP hosting centers known as TeleTech GigaPOPs®, which are located on three continents. These centers provide a fully integrated suite of voice and data routing, workforce management, quality monitoring, business analytic and storage capabilities. This enables anywhere to anywhere, real-time processing of our clients’ business needs from any location around the globe. This hub and spoke model enables us to provide our services at the lowest cost while increasing scalability, reliability, redundancy, asset utilization and the diversity of our service offerings.

 

To ensure high end-to-end security and reliability of this critical infrastructure, we monitor and manage the TeleTech GigaPOPs® 24 x 7, 365 days per year from several strategically located state-of-the-art global command centers as well as providing redundant, fail-over capabilities for each GigaPOP.

 

This platform is the foundation for new, innovative offerings including TeleTech OnDemandTM, TeleTech@Home and our suite of human capital solutions.

 

Our technology innovations have resulted in the filing of more than 20 intellectual property patent applications.

 

Globally Deployed Best Operating Practices

 

Globally deployed best operating practices assure that we can deliver a consistent, scalable, high-quality experience to our clients’ customers from any of our 58 delivery centers or work from home associates around the world. Standardized processes include our approach to attracting, screening, hiring, training, scheduling, evaluating, coaching and maximizing associate performance to meet our clients’ needs. We provide real-time reporting on performance across the globe to ensure consistency of delivery. In addition, this information provides valuable insight into what is driving customer inquiries, enabling us to proactively recommend process changes to our clients to optimize their customers’ experience.

 

With delivery centers in 17 countries, we believe this makes us one of the largest and most geographically diverse providers of customer experience solutions. We plan to selectively expand into other attractive delivery markets over time.

 

Of the 17 countries from which we provide customer experience solutions, 12 provide services for onshore clients including the U.S., Australia, Brazil, China, England, Germany, Ghana, New Zealand, Northern Ireland, Scotland, South Africa and Spain. The total number of workstations in these countries is 9,500, or 30% of our total delivery capacity.

 

The other five countries provide services, partially or entirely, for offshore clients including Argentina, Canada, Costa Rica, Mexico and the Philippines. The total number of workstations in these countries is 22,300, or 70% of our total delivery capacity.

 

Innovative Human Capital Strategies

 

To effectively manage and leverage our human capital requirements, we have developed a proprietary suite of business processes, software tools and client engagement guidelines that work together to improve performance for our clients while enabling us to reduce time to hire, decrease employee turnover and improve time to service and quality of performance.

 

5



 

The three primary components of our human capital platform – Talent Acquisition, Learning Innovation Services and Performance Optimization – combine to form a powerful and flexible management system to streamline and standardize operations across our global delivery centers. These three components work together to allow us to make better hires, improve training quality and provide real-time feedback and incentives for performance.

 

Our Historical Financial Performance

 

Due to the global economic slowdown that began in late 2008, our revenue declined from $1.4 billion in 2008 to $1.2 billion in 2011 primarily as a result of:

 

·      lower client volumes;

 

·      elongated sales cycles;

 

·      the strengthening of the U.S. dollar relative to other currencies from which we derive revenue;

 

·      an increased pace of clients migrating certain work from onshore delivery centers to offshore delivery centers; and

 

·      our decision to proactively rationalize certain underperforming businesses and geographies out of our portfolio.

 

Despite this revenue decrease, we were able to maintain our operating margin from 7.8% in 2008 to 7.9% in 2011. This was achieved primarily as a result of:

 

·      our revenue diversification efforts into greater professional and technology-based services that have a higher margin;

 

·      aligning our capacity and workforce with the current business needs;

 

·      increased utilization of our delivery centers across a 24-hour period;

 

·      leveraging our global purchasing power; and

 

·      continued expansion of services provided from our geographically diverse delivery centers.

 

Our Future Growth Goals and Strategy

 

Our business strategy to grow and diversify our revenue, increase profitability and strengthen our industry position includes the following elements:

 

·      Capitalize on the favorable trends in the global outsourcing environment, which we believe will include more companies that want to:

 

-       Modify their approach to outsourcing based on total value delivered versus the lowest priced provider;

 

-      Seek a partner that can deliver strategic consulting and operational execution around customer-centric strategies;

 

-       Focus on partners who can offer fully integrated revenue generation solutions;

 

-       Address the growing complexity of managing multiple customer communication channels including voice, self service, email, chat and text;

 

-       Take advantage of cost efficiencies through the adoption of cloud-based or managed technology solutions: and

 

-       Consolidate outsourcing partners with those that have a solid financial position, adequate capital resources to sustain a long-term relationship and globally diverse delivery capabilities across a broad range of solutions;

 

6



 

·      Deepen and broaden existing client relationships;

 

·      Continue to diversify revenue into higher-margin offerings such as professional services, talent acquisition, learning innovation services and our managed technology offerings;

 

·      Win business with new clients and focus on end-to-end offerings in targeted industries, such as healthcare, retail and financial services, where we expect accelerating adoption of customer experience management;

 

·      Continue to invest in innovative proprietary technology and new business offerings;

 

·      Improve our operating margins through selected profit improvement initiatives;

 

·      Increase asset utilization of our globally diverse delivery centers by providing services during non-peak hours with minimal incremental investment;

 

·      Scale our work-from-home offering to increase operational flexibility; and

 

·      Selectively pursue acquisitions that extend our capabilities, geographic reach and/or industry expertise.

 

As we further develop and continue to scale our strategic business units, we are continually evaluating ways to maximize shareholder value, which may include the disposition of business units, in whole or in part, that could take the form of asset sales, mergers, sales of equity interests in our subsidiaries (privately or through a public offering) or the spin-off of equity interests of our subsidiaries to our shareholders.

 

Clients

 

In 2011, none of our clients exceeded 10% of our total annual revenue. Our top five and ten clients represented 37% and 56% of total revenue in 2011, respectively. We have experienced long-term relationships with our top five clients, ranging from five to 16 years, with the majority of these clients having completed multiple contract renewals with us.

 

Certain of our communications clients also provide us with telecommunication services through transactions that are negotiated at different times and with different legal entities. These clients currently represent approximately 14% of our total annual revenue. We believe each of these supplier contracts is negotiated on an arm’s length basis and that the terms are substantially the same as those that have been negotiated with unrelated vendors. Expenditures under these supplier contracts represent less than one percent of our total operating costs.

 

Competition

 

We compete primarily with the in-house customer experience management operations of our current and potential clients. We also compete with certain companies that provide BPO services including: Accenture Ltd.; Convergys Corporation; Genpact Limited, Sykes Enterprises Incorporated and Teleperformance, among others. We work with Accenture Ltd., Computer Sciences Corporation and IBM on a sub-contract basis and approximately 10% of our total revenue is generated from relationships with these system integrators.

 

We compete primarily on the basis of our 30 years of experience, our global locations, our quality and scope of services, our speed and flexibility of implementation, our technological expertise, and our total value delivered and contractual terms. A number of competitors may have different capabilities and resources than ours. Additionally, niche providers or new entrants could capture a segment of the market by developing new systems or services that could impact our market potential.

 

7



 

Seasonality

 

Historically, we experience a seasonal increase in revenue in the fourth quarter related to higher volumes from clients primarily in retail and other industries with seasonal businesses. Also, our operating margins in the first quarter are impacted by higher payroll-related taxes predominantly in our U.S. global workforce.

 

Employees

 

As of December 31, 2011, we had approximately 42,300 employees in 24 countries. Approximately 87% of these employees held full-time positions and 80% were located outside of the U.S. We have approximately 9,000 employees outside the U.S. and Canada covered by collective bargaining agreements. In most cases, the collective bargaining agreements are mandated under national labor laws. These collective bargaining agreements include employees in the following countries:

 

 

·

In Argentina, approximately 431 employees are covered by an industry-wide collective bargaining agreement with the Confederation of Commerce Employees that expires in April 2012;

 

 

 

 

·

In Brazil, approximately 1,200 employees are covered by industry-wide collective bargaining agreements with Sintratel and SintelMark that expire in January 2013;

 

 

 

 

·

In Mexico, we have approximately 5,000 employees covered by an industry-wide collective bargaining agreement with the Federacion Obrero Sindicalista that expires in January 2013;

 

 

 

 

·

In Spain, we have approximately 2,300 employees covered by industry-wide collective bargaining agreements with COMFIA-CCOO and FES-UGT that expired in December 2009 and are currently being renegotiated; and

 

 

 

 

·

In Australia, approximately 68 employees are covered by a collective agreement adopted by TeleTech International, Pty. Ltd. under the provisions of the Contract Call Centres Award 2010 that expires in August 2012.

 

We anticipate that these agreements will be renewed and that any renewals will not impact us in a manner materially different from all other companies covered by such industry-wide agreements. We believe that our relations with our employees and unions are satisfactory. We have not experienced any material work stoppages in our ongoing business.

 

Intellectual Property and Proprietary Technology

 

Our success is partially dependent upon certain proprietary technologies and core intellectual property. We have a number of pending patent applications in the U.S. and foreign countries. Our technology is also protected under copyright laws. Additionally, we rely on trade secret protection and confidentiality and proprietary information agreements to protect our proprietary technology. We and our subsidiaries have trademarks or registered trademarks in the U.S. and other countries, including TELETECH®, the TELETECH GLOBE Design, TELETECH GIGAPOP®, TELETECH GLOBAL VENTURES®, HIREPOINT®, IDENTIFY!®, IDENTIFY! PLUS®, WORKBOOTH®, TOTAL DELIVERED VALUE®, YOUR CUSTOMER MANAGEMENT PARTNER®, 1TO1®, PEPPERS AND ROGERS GROUP®, ELOYALTY® and the ELOYALTY Design. We believe that several of our trademarks are of material importance. Some of our proprietary technology is licensed to others under corresponding license agreements. Some of our technology is licensed from others. While our competitive position could be affected by our ability to protect our intellectual property, we believe that we have generally taken commercially reasonable steps to protect our intellectual property.

 

8



 

Our Corporate Information

 

Our principal executive offices are located at 9197 South Peoria Street, Englewood, Colorado 80112 and the telephone number at that address is (303) 397-8100. Electronic copies of our Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K and Proxy Statements are available free of charge by (i) visiting the “Investors” section of our website at http://www.teletech.com or (ii) sending a written request to Investor Relations at our corporate headquarters or to investor.relations@teletech.com. The public may read and copy any materials that we file with the SEC at the SEC’s Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, NE, Room 1580, Washington, DC 20549. You may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC maintains an Internet site that contains reports, proxy and information statements, and other information regarding issuers that file electronically with the SEC at www.sec.gov. Information on our website is not incorporated by reference into this report.

 

ITEM 1A.  RISK FACTORS

 

In evaluating our business, you should carefully consider the risks and uncertainties discussed in this section, in addition to the other information presented in this Annual Report on Form 10-K. The risks and uncertainties described below may not be the only risks that we face. If any of these risks or uncertainties actually occurs, our business, financial condition or results of operation could be materially adversely affected and the market price of our common stock may decline.

 

Risks Relating to Our Business

 

Recent changes in U.S. and global economic conditions could have an adverse effect on the profitability of our business

 

Our business is directly affected by the performance of our clients and general economic conditions. Recent turmoil in the financial markets has adversely affected economic activity in the U.S. and other regions of the world in which we do business. There is evidence that this is affecting demand for some of our services. In substantially all of our client programs, we generate revenue based, in large part, on the amount of time our employees devote to our clients’ customers. Consequently, the amount of revenue generated from any particular client program is dependent upon consumers’ interest in and use of our client’s products and/or services, which may be adversely affected by general economic conditions. Our clients may not be able to market or develop products and services that require their customers to use our services, especially as a result of the downturn in the U.S. and worldwide economy. Furthermore, a decline in our clients’ business or performance, including possible client bankruptcies, could impair their ability to pay for our services. Our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows would be adversely affected if any of our major clients were unable or unwilling, for any reason, to pay for our services.

 

A large portion of our revenue is generated from a limited number of clients, and the loss of one or more of our clients could cause a reduction in our revenue and operating results

 

We rely on strategic, long-term relationships with large, global companies in targeted industries. As a result, we derive a substantial portion of our revenue from relatively few clients. Our five largest clients collectively represented 37% of revenue in 2011 and 39% of revenue in 2010. Our ten largest clients represented 56% of revenue in 2011 and 63% of revenue in 2010. We did not have a client that represented 10% of our revenue in either 2011 or 2010.

 

We believe that a substantial portion of our total revenue will continue to be derived from a relatively small number of our clients in the future. The contracts with our ten largest clients expire between 2012 and 2013. We have historically renewed most of our contracts with our largest clients. However, there is no assurance that any contracts will be renewed or, if renewed, will be on terms as favorable as the existing contracts. The volumes and profit margins of our most significant programs may decline and we may not be able to replace such clients or programs with clients or programs that generate comparable revenue and profits. The loss of all or part of a major client’s business could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

 

9



 

Client consolidations could result in a loss of clients or contract concessions that would adversely affect our operating results

 

We serve clients in targeted industries that have historically experienced a significant level of consolidation. If one of our clients is acquired by another company (including another one of our clients), provisions in certain of our contracts allow these clients to cancel or renegotiate their contracts, or to seek contract concessions. Such consolidations may result in the termination or phasing out of an existing client contract, volume discounts and other contract concessions that could have an adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

 

Our concentration of business activities in certain geographic areas subjects us to risks that may harm our results of operations and financial condition

 

We have delivery centers in many countries, and some business activities may be concentrated in certain geographic areas, including the Philippines and Latin America. As a result, we are subject to risks that may interrupt or limit our ability to operate our delivery centers or increase the cost of operating in these geographic areas, which could harm our results of operations and financial condition, including:

 

·      security concerns, such as armed conflict and civil or military unrest, crime, political instability or terrorist activity;

 

·      health concerns;

 

·      natural disasters;

 

·      inefficient and limited infrastructure and disruptions, such as large-scale outages or interruptions of service from utilities, transportation, or telecommunications providers;

 

·      restrictions on our operations by governments seeking to support local industries, nationalization of our operations, and restrictions on our ability to repatriate earnings;

 

·      differing employment practices, prevailing wage rates and labor issues;

 

·      local business and cultural factors that differ from our normal standards and practices, including business practices that we are prohibited from engaging in by the Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and other anti-corruption laws and regulations; and

 

·      regulatory requirements and prohibitions that differ among jurisdictions.

 

We may be disproportionately exposed to interruption of or limitations to the operation of our business or increases in operating costs in these geographic areas due to these or other factors.  As a result, any interruption or limitation of, or increase in costs related to, our operations in these geographic areas could harm our results of operations and financial condition.

 

10



 

Unauthorized disclosure of sensitive or confidential client and customer data could expose us to protracted and costly litigation, penalties and cause us to lose clients

 

We are dependent on IT networks and systems to process, transmit and store electronic information and to communicate among our locations around the world and with our alliance partners and clients. Security breaches of this infrastructure could lead to shutdowns or disruptions of our systems and potential unauthorized disclosure of confidential information. We are also required at times to manage, utilize and store sensitive or confidential client or customer data. As a result, we are subject to numerous U.S. and foreign laws and regulations designed to protect this information, such as the European Union Directive on Data Protection and various U.S. federal and state laws governing the protection of health or other individually identifiable information. If any person, including any of our employees, negligently disregards or intentionally breaches our established controls with respect to such data or otherwise mismanages or misappropriates that data, we could be subject to monetary damages, fines and/or criminal prosecution. Unauthorized disclosure of sensitive or confidential client or customer data, whether through systems failure, employee negligence, fraud or misappropriation, could damage our reputation and cause us to lose clients. Similarly, unauthorized access to or through our information systems or those we develop for our clients, whether by our employees or third parties, could result in negative publicity, legal liability and damage to our reputation, business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

 

Our financial results depend on our capacity utilization, in particular our ability to forecast our clients’ customer demand and make corresponding decisions regarding staffing levels, investments and operating expenses

 

Our delivery center utilization rates have a substantial and direct effect on our profitability, and we may not achieve desired utilization rates. Our utilization rates are affected by a number of factors, including:

 

·      Our ability to maintain and increase capacity in each of our delivery centers during peak and non-peak hours;

 

·      Our ability to predict our clients’ customer demand for our services and thereby to make corresponding decisions regarding staffing levels, investments and other operating expenditures in each of our delivery center locations;

 

·      Our ability to hire and assimilate new employees and manage employee turnover; and

 

·      Our need to devote time and resources to training, professional development and other non-chargeable activities.

 

However, because the majority of our business is inbound from our clients’ customer-initiated encounters, we have significantly higher utilization during peak (weekday) periods than during off-peak (night and weekend) periods. We have experienced periods of idle capacity, particularly in our multi-client delivery centers. Historically, we experience idle peak period capacity upon opening a new delivery center or termination or completion of a large client program. We may consolidate or close under-performing delivery centers in order to maintain or improve targeted utilization and margins. In the event we close delivery centers in the future, we may be required to record restructuring or impairment charges, which could adversely impact our results of operations. There can be no assurance that we will be able to achieve or maintain desired delivery center capacity utilization. As a result of the fixed costs associated with each delivery center, quarterly variations in client volumes, many of which are outside our control, can have a material adverse effect on our utilization rates. If our utilization rates are below expectations in any given period, our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows for that period could be adversely affected.

 

11



 

Our business depends on uninterrupted service to clients

 

Our operations are dependent upon our ability to protect our facilities, computer and telecommunications equipment and software systems against damage or interruption from fire, power loss, terrorist or cyber attacks, sabotage, telecommunications interruption or failure, labor shortages, weather conditions, natural disasters and other similar events. Additionally, severe weather can cause our employees to miss work and interrupt the delivery of our services, resulting in a loss of revenue. In the event we experience a temporary or permanent interruption at one or more of our locations (including our corporate headquarters building), our business could be materially adversely affected and we may be required to pay contractual damages or face the suspension or loss of a client’s business. Further, the impacts associated with global climate change, such as rising sea levels or increased and intensified storm activity, may cause increased business interruptions or may require the relocation of our facilities located in low-lying coastal areas. Although we maintain property and business interruption insurance, such insurance may not adequately compensate us for any losses we may incur.

 

Many of our contracts utilize performance pricing that link some of our fees to the attainment of various performance or business targets, which could increase the variability of our revenue and operating margin

 

A majority of our contracts include performance clauses that condition some of our fees on the achievement of agreed-upon performance standards or milestones. These performance standards can be complex and often depend in some measure on our clients’ actual levels of business activity or other factors outside of our control. If we fail to satisfy these measures, it could reduce our revenue under the contracts or subject us to potential damage claims under the contract terms.

 

Our contracts provide for early termination, which could have a material adverse effect on our operating results

 

Most of our contracts do not ensure that we will generate a minimum level of revenue and the profitability of each client program may fluctuate, sometimes significantly, throughout the various stages of a program. Our contracts generally enable the clients to terminate the contract or reduce customer interaction volumes. Our larger contracts generally require the client to pay a contractually agreed amount and/or provide prior notice in the event of early termination. There can be no assurance that we will be able to collect early termination fees.

 

We may not be able to offset increased costs with increased service fees under long-term contracts

 

Some of our larger long-term contracts allow us to increase our service fees if and to the extent certain cost or price indices increase. The majority of our expenses are payroll and payroll-related, which includes healthcare costs. Over the past several years, payroll costs, including healthcare costs, have increased at a rate much greater than that of general cost or price indices. Increases in our service fees that are based upon increases in cost or price indices may not fully compensate us for increases in labor and other costs incurred in providing services. There can be no assurance that we will be able to recover increases in our costs through increased service fees.

 

Our business may be affected by our ability to obtain financing

 

From time to time, we may need to obtain debt or equity financing for capital expenditures, stock repurchases, payment of existing obligations, replenishment of cash reserves, acquisitions or joint ventures. Additionally, our existing credit facility requires us to comply with certain financial covenants. There can be no assurance that we will be able to obtain additional debt or equity financing, or that any such financing would be on terms acceptable to us. Furthermore, there can be no assurance that we will be able to meet the financial covenants under our debt agreements or, in the event of noncompliance, will be able to obtain waivers or amendments from the lenders.

 

12



 

Our business may be affected by risks associated with international operations and expansion

 

An important component of our growth strategy is continued international expansion. There are certain risks inherent with conducting international business, including but not limited to:

 

·      Management of personnel overseas;

 

·      Longer payment cycles and/or difficulties in accounts receivable collections;

 

·      Foreign currency exchange rates;

 

·      Difficulties in complying with foreign laws;

 

·      Unexpected changes in regulatory requirements;

 

·      Political and social instability, as demonstrated by terrorist threats, regime change, increasing tension in the Middle East and other regions, and the resulting need for enhanced security measures; and

 

·      Potentially adverse tax consequences.

 

Any one or more of these or other factors could have a material adverse effect on our international operations and, consequently, on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flow. There can be no assurance that we will be able to manage our international operations successfully.

 

Our financial results may be impacted by foreign currency exchange risk

 

We serve an increasing number of our clients from delivery centers in other countries such as Argentina, Canada, Costa Rica, Mexico, and the Philippines. Contracts with these clients are typically priced, invoiced, and paid in U.S. dollars or other foreign currencies while the costs incurred to operate these delivery centers are denominated in the functional currency of the applicable operating subsidiary. Therefore, fluctuations between the currencies of the contracting and operating subsidiary present foreign currency exchange risks. In addition, because our financial statements are denominated in U.S. dollars, and approximately 29% of our revenue is derived from contracts denominated in other currencies, our results of operations and revenue could be adversely affected if the U.S. dollar strengthens significantly against foreign currencies.

 

While we enter into forward and option contracts (collars) to hedge against the effect of exchange rate fluctuations, the foreign exchange exposure between the contracting and operating subsidiaries is not hedged 100%. Since the operating subsidiary assumes the foreign exchange exposure, its operating margins could decrease if the operating subsidiary’s currency strengthens against the contracting subsidiary’s currency. For example, our operating subsidiaries are at risk if their functional currency strengthens against the contracting subsidiary’s currency (typically the U.S. dollar). If the U.S. dollar devalues against the operating subsidiaries’ functional currency, the financial results of those operating subsidiaries and TeleTech (upon consolidation) will be negatively affected. While our hedging strategy effectively offsets a portion of these foreign currency changes, there can be no assurance that we will be able to continue to successfully hedge this foreign currency exchange risk or that the value of the U.S. dollar will not materially weaken. If we fail to manage our foreign currency exchange risk, our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows could be adversely affected.

 

We are subject to counterparty credit risk and market risk with respect to financial transactions with our financial institutions

 

The recent global economic and credit crisis weakened the creditworthiness of many financial institutions, and in some circumstances caused previously financially solvent financial institutions to file for bankruptcy.

 

13



 

The counterparties to our hedge transactions are financial institutions or affiliates of financial institutions, and we are subject to risks that these counterparties become insolvent and fail to perform their financial obligations under these hedge transactions. Our hedging exposure to counterparty credit risk is not secured by any collateral. If one or more of the counterparties to one or more of our hedge transactions becomes subject to insolvency proceedings, we will become an unsecured creditor in those proceedings with a claim equal to our exposure at the time under those transactions. Our primary exposure will depend on many factors but, generally, our credit exposure will depend on foreign exchange rate movements relative to the contracted foreign exchange rate and whether any gains result that are not realized due to a counterparty default. While all of our counterparty financial institutions were investment grade rated by the national rating agencies as of December 31, 2011, we can provide no assurances as to the financial stability or viability of any of our counterparties.

 

We also have a revolving credit facility with a syndicate of financial institutions, and interest rate swaps with counterparty banks, that were investment grade rated at December 31, 2011. We can provide no assurances as to the financial stability or viability of these financial and other institutions and their ability to fund their obligations when required under our agreements.

 

Our global operations expose us to numerous and sometimes conflicting legal and regulatory requirements

 

Because we provide services to our clients’ customers, who reside in 90 countries, we are subject to numerous, and sometimes conflicting, legal regimes on matters as diverse as import/export controls, content requirements, trade restrictions, tariffs, taxation, sanctions, government affairs, immigration, internal and disclosure control obligations, data privacy and labor relations. Violations of these regulations could result in liability for monetary damages, fines and/or criminal prosecution, unfavorable publicity, restrictions on our ability to process information and allegations by our clients that we have not performed our contractual obligations. Due to the varying degrees of development of the legal systems of the countries in which we operate, local laws might be insufficient to protect our contractual and intellectual property rights, among other rights.

 

Changes in U.S. federal, state and international laws and regulations may adversely affect the sale of our services, including expansion of overseas operations. In the U.S., some of our services must comply with various federal and state regulations regarding the method of placing outbound telephone calls. In addition, we could incur liability for failure to comply with laws or regulations related to the portions of our clients’ businesses that are transferred to us. Changes in these regulations and requirements, or new restrictive regulations and requirements, may slow the growth of our services or require us to incur substantial costs. Changes in laws and regulations could also mandate significant and costly changes to the way we implement our services and solutions, such as preventing us from using offshore resources to provide our services, or could impose additional taxes on the provision of our services and solutions. These changes could threaten our ability to continue to serve certain markets.

 

Our financial results and projections may be impacted by our ability to maintain and find new locations for our delivery centers in countries with stable wage rates

 

Our industry is labor-intensive and the majority of our operating costs relate to wages, employee benefits and employment taxes. As a result, our future growth is dependent upon our ability to find cost-effective locations in which to operate, both domestically and internationally. Some of our delivery centers are located in countries that have experienced rising standards of living, which may in turn require us to increase employee wages. In addition, approximately 9,000 employees outside the U.S. are covered by collective bargaining agreements. Although we anticipate that the terms of agreements will not impact us in a manner materially different than other companies located in these countries, we may not be able to pass increased labor costs on to our clients. There is no assurance that we will be able to find cost-effective locations. Any increases in labor costs may have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

 

14



 

The business process outsourcing markets are highly competitive, and we might not be able to compete effectively

 

Our ability to compete will depend on a number of factors, including our ability to:

 

·      Initiate, develop and maintain new client relationships;

 

·      Maintain and expand existing client programs;

 

·      Staff and equip suitable delivery center facilities in a timely manner; and

 

·      Develop new solutions and enhance existing solutions we provide to our clients.

 

Moreover, we compete with a variety of companies with respect to our offerings, including:

 

·      Large multinational providers, including the service arms of large global technology providers;

 

·      Offshore service providers in lower-cost locations that offer services similar to those we offer, often at highly competitive prices;

 

·      Niche solution or service providers that compete with us in a specific geographic market, industry segment or service area; and

 

·      Most importantly, the in-house operations of clients or potential clients.

 

Because our primary competitors are the in-house operations of existing or potential clients, our performance and growth could be adversely affected if our existing or potential clients decide to provide in-house business process services they currently outsource, or retain or increase their in-house business processing services and product support capabilities. In addition, competitive pressures from current or future competitors also could cause our services to lose market acceptance or put downward pressure on the prices we charge for our services and on our operating margins. If we are unable to provide our clients with superior services and solutions at competitive prices, our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows could be adversely affected.

 

We may not be able to develop our services and solutions in response to changes in technology and client demand

 

Our success depends on our ability to develop and implement systems technology and outsourcing services and solutions that anticipate and respond to rapid and continuing changes in technology, industry developments and client needs. Our continued growth and future profitability will be highly dependent on a number of factors, including our ability to develop new technologies that:

 

·      Expand our existing solutions and offerings;

 

·      Achieve cost efficiencies in our existing delivery center operations; and

 

·      Introduce new solutions that leverage and respond to changing technological developments.

 

We may not be successful in anticipating or responding to these developments on a timely basis. Our integration of new technologies may not achieve their intended cost reductions and services and technologies offered by current or future competitors may make our service offerings uncompetitive or obsolete. Our failure to maintain our technological capabilities or to respond effectively to technological changes could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

 

15



 

Disruption to the Company’s supply chain for eLoyalty could adversely affect our eLoyalty business

 

Damage or disruption to the suppliers for the Company’s eLoyalty subsidiary or to the Company’s distribution capabilities due to weather, natural disaster, fire, terrorism, pandemic, strikes, or other reasons could impair eLoyalty’s ability to sell its products and services. Failure to take adequate steps to mitigate the likelihood or potential impact of such events, or to effectively manage such events if they occur, particularly when a product is sourced from a single location, could adversely affect the Company’s business or financial results.

 

Our business could be negatively impacted by security threats and other disruptions

 

Major equipment failures, natural disasters, including severe weather, terrorist acts, cyber attacks or other breaches of network or information technology security that affect our wireline and GigaPOP networks, including transport facilities, communications switches, routers, or other equipment or third-party owned local and long-distance networks on which we rely, could have a material adverse effect on our operations. These events could disrupt our operations, require significant resources, result in a loss of clients or impair our ability to attract new clients, which in turn could have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

The products and services utilized by us and our suppliers may infringe on intellectual property rights owned by others

 

Some of our products and services use intellectual property that we own. We also purchase products and services from suppliers, including device suppliers and service providers that incorporate or utilize intellectual property. We and some of our suppliers and service providers have received, and may receive in the future, assertions and claims from third parties that the products of software utilized by us or our suppliers and service providers infringe on the patents or other intellectual property rights of these third parties. These claims could require us or an infringing supplier or service provider to cease certain activities or to cease selling the relevant products and services. These claims and assertions also could subject us to costly litigation and significant liabilities for damages or royalty payments, or require us to cease certain activities or to cease selling certain products and services.

 

The intellectual property that we develop may not be unique or may become obsolete or outdated

 

Some of the intellectual property developed by us may not receive favorable treatment from the United States Patent and Trademark Office or similar foreign intellectual property adjudication and registration agencies. Intellectual property for which we have a patent pending status may not be granted a patent or may be determined to have been filed later than similar technologies products and services or may be determined to materially conflict with similar technologies, products and services. Technologies, products and services upon which we rely to provide services to our clients or which serve to differentiate our services from our competitors may become obsolete or outdated. All of these factors could in turn have a material adverse effect on our business, results of operations and financial condition.

 

If we fail to recruit, hire, train and retain key executives or qualified employees, our business will be adversely affected

 

Our business is labor intensive and places significant importance on our ability to recruit, train, and retain qualified personnel. We generally experience high employee turnover and are continuously required to recruit and train replacement personnel as a result of a changing and expanding work force. Demand for qualified technical professionals conversant in multiple languages, including English, and/or certain technologies may exceed supply, as new and additional skills are required to keep pace with evolving technologies. In addition, certain delivery centers are located in geographic areas with relatively low unemployment rates, which could make it more costly to hire qualified personnel. Our ability to locate and train employees is critical to achieving our growth objective. Our inability to attract and retain qualified personnel or an increase in wages or other costs of attracting, training, or retaining qualified personnel could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

 

16



 

Our success is also dependent upon the efforts, direction and guidance of our executive management team. Although members of our executive team are subject to non-competition agreements, they can terminate their employment at any time. The loss of any member of our senior management team could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows and growth potential.

 

If we fail to integrate businesses and assets that we may acquire through joint ventures or acquisitions, we may lose clients and our liquidity, capital resources and profitability may be adversely affected

 

We may pursue joint ventures or strategic acquisitions of companies with services, technologies, industry specializations, or geographic coverage that extend or complement our existing business. Acquisitions and joint ventures often involve a number of special risks, including the following:

 

·      We may encounter difficulties integrating acquired software, operations and personnel and our management’s attention could be diverted from other business concerns;

 

·      We may not be able to successfully incorporate acquired technology and rights into our service offerings and maintain uniform standards, controls, procedures and policies;

 

·      The businesses or assets we acquire may fail to achieve the revenue and earnings we anticipated, causing us to incur additional debt to fund operations and to impair the assets from our acquisitions;

 

·      We may assume liabilities associated with the sale of the acquired company’s products or services;

 

·      Our resources may be diverted in asserting and defending our legal rights and we may ultimately be liable for contingent and other liabilities, not previously disclosed to us, of the companies that we acquire;

 

·      Acquisitions may disrupt our ongoing business and dilute our ownership interest;

 

·      Acquisitions may result in litigation from former employees or third parties; and

 

·      Due diligence may fail to identify significant issues with product quality, product architecture, ownership rights and legal contingencies, among other matters.

 

We may pursue strategic alliances in the form of joint ventures and partnerships, which involve many of the same risks as acquisitions as well as additional risks associated with possible lack of control if we do not have a majority ownership position. Any of the factors identified above could have a material adverse effect on our business and on the market value of our common stock.

 

In addition, negotiation of potential acquisitions and the resulting integration of acquired businesses, products, or technologies, could divert management’s time and resources. Future acquisitions could cause us to issue dilutive equity or incur debt, contingent liabilities, additional amortization charges from intangible assets, asset impairment charges, or impairment charges for in-process research and development and other indefinite-lived intangible assets that could adversely affect our business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

 

17



 

We face risks related to health epidemics, which could disrupt our business and have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations

 

Our business could be materially and adversely affected by health epidemics, including, but not limited to, outbreaks of the H1N1 influenza virus (commonly known as the “swine flu”), the avian flu, and severe acute respiratory syndrome (“SARS”). Outbreaks of SARS in 2003 and 2004 and the avian flu in 2006, 2007 and 2008 alarmed people around the world, raising issues pertaining to health and travel and undermining confidence in the world’s economy. More recently, cases of the H1N1 virus have been identified internationally, including confirmed human outbreaks and deaths. Any prolonged epidemic of the H1N1 virus, avian flu, SARS, or other contagious infection in the markets in which we do business may result in worker absences, lower asset utilization rates, voluntary closure of our offices and delivery centers, travel restrictions on our employees, and other disruptions to our business. Moreover, health epidemics may force local health and government authorities to mandate the closure of our offices and delivery centers. Any prolonged or widespread health epidemic could severely disrupt our business operations, result in a significant decrease in demand for our services, and have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, results of operations and cash flows.

 

The adoption and implementation of new statutory and regulatory requirements for derivative transactions could have an adverse impact on our ability to hedge risks associated with our business

 

We enter into forward and option contracts to hedge against the effect of foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations and interest rate fluctuations. The United States Congress has passed, and the President has signed into law, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Financial Reform Act”). The Financial Reform Act provides for new statutory and regulatory requirements for derivative transactions, including foreign currency and interest rate hedging transactions. The Financial Reform Act requires the Commodities Futures and Trading Commission to promulgate rules relating to the Financial Reform Act. Until the rules relating to the Financial Reform Act are established, we do not know how these regulations will affect us. The rules adopted by the Commodities Futures and Trading Commission may in the future impact our flexibility to execute strategic hedges to reduce foreign exchange and interest rate uncertainty and thus protect cash flows. In addition, the banks and other derivatives dealers who are our contractual counterparties will be required to comply with the Financial Reform Act’s new requirements. It is possible that the costs of such compliance will be passed on to customers such as ourselves.

 

Risks Relating to Our Common Stock

 

The market price for our common stock may be volatile

 

The trading price of our common stock has been volatile and may be subject to wide fluctuations in response to, among other factors, the following:

 

·      Actual or anticipated variations in our quarterly results;

 

·      Announcements of new contracts or contract cancellations;

 

·      Changes in financial estimates by securities analysts;

 

·      Our ability to meet the expectations of securities analysts;

 

·      Conditions or trends in the business process outsourcing industry;

 

·      Changes in the market valuations of other business process outsourcing companies;

 

·      Developments in countries where we have significant delivery centers, GigaPOPs or operations;

 

·      The ability of our clients to pay for our services; or

 

·      Other events or factors, many of which are beyond our control.

 

18



 

In addition, the stock market in general, the NASDAQ Global Select Market and the market for BPO providers in particular have experienced extreme price and volume fluctuations that have often been unrelated or disproportionate to the operating performance of particular companies. These broad market and industry factors may materially and adversely affect our stock price, regardless of our operating performance.

 

You may suffer significant dilution as a result of our outstanding stock options and our equity incentive programs

 

We have adopted benefit plans for the compensation of our employees and directors under which restricted stock units (“RSUs”) and options to purchase our common stock have been and will continue to be granted. Options to purchase approximately 1.5 million shares of our common stock were outstanding at December 31, 2011, of which approximately 1.3 million shares were exercisable. RSUs representing approximately 2.5 million shares were outstanding at December 31, 2011, all of which were unvested. The large number of shares issuable upon exercise of our options and other equity incentive grants could have a significant depressing effect on the market price of our stock and cause dilution to the earnings per share of our common stock.

 

Our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer has control over all matters requiring action by our stockholders

 

Kenneth D. Tuchman, our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, beneficially owns approximately 56.7% of our common stock. As a result, Mr. Tuchman could exercise control over all matters requiring action by our stockholders, including the election of our entire Board of Directors. Therefore, a change in control of our company could not be effected without his approval.

 

Our controls and procedures may not prevent or detect all errors or acts of fraud

 

Our management, including our CEO and CFO, believes that any disclosure controls and procedures or internal controls and procedures, no matter how well conceived and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system are met. Further, the design of a control system must consider the benefits of controls relative to their costs. Inherent limitations within a control system include the realities that judgments in decision-making can be faulty, and that breakdowns can occur because of simple error or mistake. Additionally, controls can be circumvented by the individual acts of some persons, by collusion of two or more people or by an unauthorized override of the controls. While the design of any system of controls is to provide reasonable assurance of the effectiveness of disclosure controls, such design is also based in part upon certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events, and such assumptions, while reasonable, may not take into account all potential future conditions. Accordingly, because of the inherent limitations in a cost effective control system, misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and may not be prevented or detected.

 

Failure to maintain an effective system of internal control over financial reporting may have an adverse effect on our stock price

 

Pursuant to Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, and the rules and regulations promulgated by the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) to implement Section 404, we are required to furnish a report by our management to include in this Form 10-K regarding the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting. The report includes, among other things, an assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of the end of our fiscal year, including a statement as to whether or not our internal control over financial reporting is effective. This assessment must include disclosure of any material weaknesses in our internal control over financial reporting identified by management. We have in the past discovered, and may potentially in the future discover, areas of internal control over financial reporting which may require improvement. If we are unable to assert that our internal control over financial reporting is effective now or in any future period, or if our auditors are unable to express an opinion on the effectiveness of our internal controls, we could lose investor confidence in the accuracy and completeness of our financial reports, which could have an adverse effect on our stock price.

 

19



 

ITEM 1B.  UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

 

We have not received written comments regarding our periodic or current reports from the staff of the SEC that were issued 180 days or more preceding the end of our 2011 fiscal year that remain unresolved.

 

ITEM 2.  PROPERTIES

 

Our corporate headquarters are located in Englewood, Colorado, which consists of approximately 264,000 square feet of owned office space. In addition to the delivery centers discussed below, we also have small sales and consulting offices in several countries around the world.

 

As of December 31, 2011, excluding delivery centers we have exited, we operated 58 delivery centers that are classified as follows:

 

·                  Multi-Client Center — We lease space for these centers and serve multiple clients in each facility;

 

·                  Dedicated Center — We lease space for these centers and dedicate the entire facility to one client; and

 

·                  Managed Center — These facilities are leased or owned by our clients and we staff and manage these sites on behalf of our clients in accordance with facility management contracts.

 

As of December 31, 2011, our delivery centers were located in the following countries:

 

 

 

Multi-Client
Centers

 

Dedicated
Centers

 

Managed
Centers

 

Total
Number of
Delivery
Centers

 

Argentina

 

2

 

-

 

2

 

4

 

Australia

 

2

 

1

 

-

 

3

 

Brazil

 

1

 

-

 

-

 

1

 

Canada

 

3

 

-

 

1

 

4

 

China

 

-

 

-

 

1

 

1

 

Costa Rica

 

1

 

-

 

-

 

1

 

England

 

-

 

-

 

1

 

1

 

Germany

 

-

 

-

 

1

 

1

 

Ghana

 

1

 

-

 

-

 

1

 

Mexico

 

3

 

-

 

-

 

3

 

New Zealand

 

1

 

-

 

-

 

1

 

Northern Ireland

 

1

 

-

 

-

 

1

 

Philippines

 

14

 

-

 

-

 

14

 

Scotland

 

-

 

1

 

1

 

2

 

South Africa

 

-

 

-

 

1

 

1

 

Spain

 

5

 

-

 

-

 

5

 

United States of America

 

6

 

3

 

5

 

14

 

Total

 

40

 

5

 

13

 

58

 

 

The leases for our delivery centers have remaining terms ranging from one to seven years and generally contain renewal options, with the exception of one center which we have subleased thru the lease completion in 2021. We believe that our existing delivery centers are suitable and adequate for our current operations, and we have plans to build additional centers to accommodate future business.

 

20



 

ITEM 3.  LEGAL PROCEEDINGS

 

From time to time, we have been involved in claims and lawsuits, both as plaintiff and defendant, which arise in the ordinary course of business. Accruals for claims or lawsuits have been provided for to the extent that losses are deemed both probable and estimable. Although the ultimate outcome of these claims or lawsuits cannot be ascertained, on the basis of present information and advice received from counsel, we believe that the disposition or ultimate resolution of such claims or lawsuits will not have a material adverse effect on our financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

 

ITEM 4.  MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURES

 

We are not an operator, and we do not have any subsidiary that is an operator, of a coal or other mine.

 

PART II

 

ITEM 5.  MARKET FOR REGISTRANT’S COMMON EQUITY, RELATED STOCKHOLDER
MATTERS AND ISSUER PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES

 

Our common stock is traded on the NASDAQ Global Select Market under the symbol “TTEC.” The following table sets forth the range of the high and low sales prices per share of the common stock for the quarters indicated as reported on the NASDAQ Global Select Market:

 

 

 

High

 

 

Low

 

Fourth Quarter 2011

 

$

18.66

 

$

14.10

 

Third Quarter 2011

 

$

22.39

 

$

14.18

 

Second Quarter 2011

 

$

21.15

 

$

17.31

 

First Quarter 2011

 

$

23.46

 

$

17.80

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fourth Quarter 2010

 

$

22.00

 

$

14.24

 

Third Quarter 2010

 

$

15.33

 

$

12.17

 

Second Quarter 2010

 

$

18.13

 

$

12.28

 

First Quarter 2010

 

$

20.95

 

$

16.64

 

 

As of December 31, 2011, we had approximately 496 holders of record of our common stock. We have never declared or paid any dividends on our common stock and we do not expect to do so in the foreseeable future.

 

Stock Repurchase Program

 

The Company has a stock repurchase program which was initially authorized by the Company’s Board of Directors in November 2001. The Board periodically authorizes additional increases to the program. As of December 31, 2011, the cumulative authorized repurchase allowance was $462.3 million, of which we have purchased 32.2 million shares for $430.6 million. As of December 31, 2011, the remaining allowance under the program was approximately $31.7 million. For the period from January 1, 2012 through February 23, 2012, we have purchased an additional 0.2 million shares for $2.4 million. The stock repurchase program does not have an expiration date.

 

21



 

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities During the Fourth Quarter of 2011

 

The following table provides information about our repurchases of equity securities during the quarter ended December 31, 2011:

 

Period

 

Total Number
of Shares

Purchased

 

Average Price
Paid per Share

 

Total Number of
Shares
Purchased as
Part of Publicly
Announced
Plans or
Programs

 

 

Approximate Dollar
Value of Shares that
May Yet Be
Purchased Under
the Plans or
Programs (In
thousands)

 

September 30, 2011

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

36,991

 

October 1, 2011 - October 31, 2011

 

165,089

 

$

15.34

 

165,089

 

 

$

34,457

 

November 1, 2011 - November 30, 2011

 

8,400

 

$

16.04

 

8,400

 

 

$

34,322

 

December 1, 2011 - December 31, 2011

 

165,300

 

$

16.08

 

165,300

 

 

$

31,663

 

Total

 

338,789

 

 

 

338,789

 

 

 

 

 

Equity Compensation Plan Information

 

The following table sets forth, as of December 31, 2011, the number of shares of our common stock to be issued upon exercise of outstanding options, RSUs, warrants and rights, the weighted-average exercise price of outstanding options, warrants and rights, and the number of securities available for future issuance under equity-based compensation plans.

 

Plan Category

 

Number of
Securities to be
Issued Upon
Exercise of
Outstanding
Options, RSUs,
Warrants and
Rights (a)

 

 

Weighted-
Average Exercise
Price of
Outstanding
Options,
Warrants and
Rights (b)

 

Number of Securities
Remaining Available for
Future Issuance Under
Equity Compensation
Plans (Excluding
Securities Reflected in
Column (a))

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equity compensation plans approved by security holders

 

4,009,380

(1)

$

12.48

(2)

2,858,354

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders

 

-

 

$

-

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

4,009,380

 

 

 

2,858,354

 

 

(1)      Includes options to purchase 1,462,508 shares and 2,546,872 RSUs issued under our equity incentive plans.

(2)      Weighted average exercise price of outstanding stock options; excludes RSUs, which have no exercise price.

 

Stock Performance Graph

 

The graph depicted below compares the performance of TeleTech common stock with the performance of the NASDAQ Composite Index; the Russell 2000 Index; and customized peer group over the period beginning on December 31, 2006 and ending on December 31, 2011. We have chosen a “Peer Group” composed of Convergys Corporation (NYSE: CVG), Genpact Limited (NYSE: G), Sykes Enterprises, Incorporated (NASDAQ: SYKE) and Teleperformance (NYSE Euronext: RCF). We believe that the companies in the Peer Group are relevant to our current business model, market capitalization and position in the overall BPO industry.

 

22



 

The graph assumes that $100 was invested on December 31, 2006 in our common stock and in each comparison index, and that all dividends were reinvested. We have not declared any dividends on our common stock. Stock price performance shown on the graph below is not necessarily indicative of future price performance.

 

COMPARISON OF 5 YEAR CUMULATIVE TOTAL RETURN*

Among TeleTech Holdings, Inc., The NASDAQ Composite Index,

The Russell 2000 Index, And A Peer Group

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

 

2006

 

2007

 

2008

 

2009

 

2010

 

2011

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc.

 

$

100

 

$

89

 

$

35

 

$

84

 

$

86

 

$

68

 

NASDAQ Composite

 

$

100

 

$

110

 

$

66

 

$

95

 

$

112

 

$

111

 

Russell 2000

 

$

100

 

$

98

 

$

65

 

$

83

 

$

105

 

$

101

 

Peer Group

 

$

100

 

$

83

 

$

49

 

$

75

 

$

78

 

$

68

 

 

 

23



 

ITEM 6.  SELECTED FINANCIAL DATA

 

The following selected financial data should be read in conjunction with Item 7. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations, the Consolidated Financial Statements and the related notes appearing elsewhere in this Form 10-K (amounts in thousands except per share amounts).

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

2008

 

2007

 

Statement of Operations Data

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue

 

$

1,179,388

(1)

$

1,094,906

 

$

1,167,915

 

$

1,400,147

 

$

1,369,632

 

Cost of services

 

(848,362)

 

(789,697)

 

(820,517)

 

(1,024,451)

(9)

(1,001,459)

(9)

Selling, general and administrative

 

(188,802)

 

(165,812)

 

(180,039)

 

(199,495)

 

(207,528)

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

(44,889)

 

(50,218)

 

(56,991)

 

(59,166)

 

(55,953)

 

Other operating expenses

 

(3,881)

(2)

(15,434)

(5)

(9,659)

(8)

(8,077)

(10)

(22,904)

(12)

Income from operations

 

93,454

 

73,745

 

100,709

 

108,958

 

81,788

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other income (expense)

 

(1,900)

 

8,224

(6)

2,334

 

(4,354)

 

(6,437)

(13)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for income taxes

 

(13,279)

(3)

(28,431)

(7)

(27,477)

 

(27,269)

(11)

(19,562)

 

Noncontrolling interest

 

(4,101)

 

(3,664)

 

(3,812)

 

(3,588)

 

(2,686)

 

Net income attributable to TeleTech stockholders

 

$

74,174

 

$

49,874

 

$

71,754

 

$

73,747

 

$

53,103

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

56,669

 

60,361

 

62,891

 

68,208

 

70,228

 

Diluted

 

57,963

 

61,792

 

64,238

 

69,578

 

72,638

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income per share attributable to TeleTech stockholders

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

1.31

 

$

0.83

 

$

1.14

 

$

1.08

 

$

0.76

 

Diluted

 

$

1.28

 

$

0.81

 

$

1.12

 

$

1.06

 

$

0.73

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance Sheet Data

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total assets

 

$

746,978

(4)

$

660,623

 

$

640,167

 

$

668,942

 

$

760,295

 

Total long-term liabilities

 

$

106,720

(4)

$

33,554

 

$

38,300

 

$

127,949

 

$

118,729

 

 

(1)

Includes $80.0 million in revenue generated by PRG and eLoyalty.

(2)

Includes $3.6 million expense related to reductions in force, $0.1 million expense related to facilities exit charges, and $0.2 million expense related to the impairment of property and equipment.

(3)

Includes an $8.6 million expense related to the adverse decision by the Canada Revenue Agency regarding the Company’s request for relief from double taxation, an $11.7 million benefit related to the Company’s mediated settlement with the IRS related to U.S. tax refund claims, a $1.4 million benefit related to the 2010 foreign earnings repatriation, and $0.2 million benefit for other discrete items.

(4)

The Company spent $38.0 million for the acquisition of eLoyalty through an increase in borrowings on its line of credit. Upon acquisition of eLoyalty, the Company acquired $64.1 million in assets and assumed $26.1 million in liabilities ($22.7 million in long-term liabilities).

(5)

Includes $13.1 million expense related to reductions in force; $0.4 million expense related to facility exit charges; and a $2.0 million expense related to the impairment of property and equipment.

(6)

Includes a $5.9 million gain due to the settlement of a Newgen legal claim.

 

24



 

(7)

Includes a $5.6 million expense related to repatriation of $105 million of foreign earnings previously considered permanently invested outside the U.S., an increase of $2.5 million in the U.S. deferred tax liability related to foreign tax assets that can no longer offset taxable income in more than one jurisdiction, an increase of $6.6 million in the deferred tax valuation allowance, and a $2.3 million tax expense related to the legal settlement included in Other income (expense) (as discussed above), offset by a $4.0 million benefit related to foreign tax planning strategies associated with the Company’s international operations.

(8)

Includes $5.5 million expense related to reductions in force; $0.6 million expense related to facility exit charges; $1.0 million benefit related to the revised estimates of facility exit charges; and a $4.6 million expense related to the impairment of property and equipment.

(9)

Includes $14.6 million and $11.5 million for 2008 and 2007, respectively, for costs incurred for the Company’s review of its equity-based compensation practices and restatement of the Consolidated Financial Statements.

(10)

Includes $3.2 million expense related to reductions in force; $2.8 million expense related to facility exit charges; and a $2.0 million expense related to the impairment of property and equipment.

(11)

Includes benefits due to the reversal of income tax valuation allowances of $3.9 million for the year 2008.

(12)

Includes $13.4 million expense related to the impairment of goodwill; $2.4 million expense related to the impairment of property and equipment; $3.7 million expense related to reductions in force; and $3.4 million expense related to facility exit charges.

(13)

Includes a net $0.9 million benefit related to the sale of assets and a $2.2 million benefit related to the execution of a software and intellectual property license agreement.

 

ITEM 7.  MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND
RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 

Executive Summary

 

TeleTech is one of the largest and most geographically diverse global providers of customer experience strategy, technology and business process outsourcing solutions. We have a 30-year history of designing, building, implementing and managing superior customer experiences across the customer lifecycle in order to maximize revenue, increase brand loyalty and optimize business processes. By delivering a high-quality customer experience through the effective integration of customer-facing, front-office processes with internal back-office processes, we enable our clients to better serve, grow and retain their customer base. We support more than 450  unique programs for approximately 175 global clients, many of whom are included in the Global 1000, which are the world’s largest companies based on market capitalization, in the automotive, broadband, cable, financial services, government, healthcare, logistics, media and entertainment, retail, technology, travel, and wireline and wireless communication industries.

 

Our fully integrated suite of technology-enabled customer-centric services span:

 

·                  Professional Services. Leveraging our proprietary, data-driven methodology, our team of management consultants partner with clients to build the business case and design the roadmap for implementing a customer-centric business strategy. We utilize highly sophisticated customer analytics to create technology-enabled, multi-channel interaction strategies to optimize and personalize the customer experience, increase brand loyalty and help clients achieve their business and financial objectives.

 

·                  Revenue Generation. Through our data-driven sales and marketing capabilities we help our clients improve revenue and profitability by targeting new or underpenetrated markets and maximizing the revenue potential of each customer. We deliver more than $1 billion in annual revenue for our clients via more than 8,000 TeleTech-designed and managed client-branded e-commerce websites. We also process more than three terabytes of customer data daily to create and implement sophisticated customer targeting and segmentation strategies to maximize customer acquisition, retention and growth.

 

25



 

·                  Customer Innovation Solutions. We redesign and manage clients’ front-office processes to deliver just-in-time, personalized, multi-channel customer experiences. Leveraging our highly trained customer experience professionals within our onshore and offshore delivery centers as well as our TeleTech@Home work-from-home agents, our solutions integrate voice, chat, e-mail, ecommerce and social media to optimize the customer experience for our clients.

 

·                  Enterprise Innovation Solutions. We redesign and manage clients’ back-office processes, such as administration, finance, accounting, logistics and distribution, to significantly advance clients’ abilities to obtain a customer-centric view of their relationships, and maximize operating efficiencies. Our delivery of integrated business processes via on our onshore, offshore or work-from-home customer experience professionals reduces operating costs and allows customer needs to be met more quickly and efficiently, resulting in higher customer satisfaction and brand loyalty and an improved competitive position.

 

·                  Managed Technology Solutions. We offer software and infrastructure as a service on a fully hosted basis. In addition, we provide the design, implementation and ongoing management of clients’ premise-based delivery center environments to enable companies to deliver a superior customer experience across all touch points on a global scale with higher quality, lower costs and reduced risk.

 

·                  Learning Innovation Training Solutions. We offer workforce training services via a blended methodology which includes virtual job-simulation environments, eLearning courses, interactive social media networking and collaboration, as well as intuitive 3D and game-based learning courses to increase speed to proficiency, improve employee engagement and retention while also lowering training expenses.

 

·                  Data Analytics. We offer and underpin all of the above solutions with a robust data analytics capability to provide real time and actionable customer insight regarding how to grow revenue, reduce customer churn, and maximize operating efficiencies.

 

Revenue in 2011 increased over the prior year due to a net increase in existing client programs, the addition of 41 new clients, and the November 2010 acquisition of Peppers & Rogers Group and the May 2011 acquisition of eLoyalty Corporation. We believe that our revenue will grow over the long-term as global demand for our services is fueled by the following trends:

 

·                  Increased focus on the customer experience. Given the strong correlation between customer satisfaction and improved profitability, we believe that more companies are increasingly focused on selecting outsourcing partners, such as TeleTech, that can deliver strategic solutions across a continuum of capabilities that are designed to grow revenue and optimize the customer experience versus merely reduce costs.

 

·                  Focus on partners who can offer multi-channel, technology-rich customer experience solutions. The rapidly changing profile of the customer and rising customer expectations are driving increased demand for personalized and seamlessly integrated multi-channel solutions that incorporate mobile devices, self-service and human-assisted channels while embedding data-driven customer insights.

 

·                  Focus on partners who can offer fully integrated revenue generation solutions. A focus on partners who can offer fully integrated revenue generation solutions to maximize the revenue and profitability potential of each customer, improve customer acquisition, retention and growth and target new or underpenetrated markets.

 

26



 

·                  Integration of front- and back-office business processes to provide increased operating efficiencies and an enhanced customer experience especially in light of the weakening global economic environment. Companies have realized that integrated business processes reduce operating costs and allow customer needs to be met more quickly and efficiently resulting in higher customer satisfaction and brand loyalty thereby improving their competitive position. A majority of our historic revenue has been derived from providing customer-facing front-office solutions to our clients. Given that our global delivery centers are also fully capable of providing back-office solutions, we are uniquely positioned to grow our revenue by winning more back-office opportunities and providing the services during non-peak hours with minimal incremental investment. Furthermore, by spreading our fixed costs across a larger revenue base and increasing our asset utilization, we expect our profitability to improve over time.

 

·                  Increasing percentage of company operations being outsourced to most capable third-party partners. Having experienced success with outsourcing a portion of their business processes, companies are increasingly inclined to outsource a larger percentage of this work. We believe companies will continue to consolidate their business processes with third-party partners, such as TeleTech, who are financially stable and able to invest in their business while also demonstrating an extensive global operating history and an ability to cost effectively scale to meet their evolving needs.

 

·                  Increasing adoption of outsourcing across broader groups of industries. Early adopters of the business process outsourcing trend, such as the media and communications industries, are being joined by companies in other industries, including healthcare, retail and financial services. These companies are beginning to adopt outsourcing to improve their business processes and competitiveness. For example, we see increasing interest in our services from companies in the healthcare, retail and financial services industries. We believe the number of other industries that will adopt or increase their level of outsourcing will continue to grow, further enabling us to increase and diversify our revenue and client base.

 

·                  Focus on speed-to-market by companies launching new products or entering new geographic locations. As companies broaden their product offerings and seek to enter new emerging markets, they are looking for outsourcing partners that can provide speed-to-market while reducing their capital and operating risk. To achieve these benefits, companies are seeking BPO partners with an extensive operating history, an established global footprint, the financial strength to invest in innovation to deliver more strategic capabilities and the ability to scale and meet customer demands quickly. Given our financial stability, geographic presence in 23 countries and our significant investment in standardized technology and processes, we believe that clients select TeleTech because we can quickly ramp large, complex business processes around the globe in a short period of time while assuring a high-quality experience for their customers.

 

Our Strategy

 

Our objective is to become the world’s largest, most technologically advanced and innovative provider of customer-centric customer experience solutions. Companies within the Global 1000 are our primary client targets due to their size, global reach, and desire for a partner who can quickly and efficiently offer an end-to-end suite of fully-integrated, globally scalable solutions. We have developed, and continue to invest in, a broad set of technological and geographical capabilities designed to serve this growing client need. These investments include our 2010 acquisition of a majority interest in Peppers & Rogers Group to further enhance our professional services capabilities and our 2011 acquisition of eLoyalty to enhance our systems integration and telephony and technology offerings. In addition, we have begun to offer cloud-based ‘hosted services’ where clients can license any aspect of our global network and proprietary applications. While the revenue from these offerings is small relative to our consolidated revenue, we believe it will continue to grow as these services become more widely adopted by our clients. We aim to further improve our competitive position by investing in a growing suite of new and innovative business process services across our targeted industries.

 

27



 

Our business strategy to grow and diversify our revenue, increase profitability and strengthen our industry position includes the following elements:

 

·                Capitalize on the favorable trends in the global outsourcing environment, which we believe will include more companies that want to:

 

-                    Modify their approach to outsourcing based on total value delivered versus the lowest priced provider;

 

-                  Seek a partner that can deliver strategic consulting and operational execution around customer-centric strategies;

 

-                    Focus on partners who can offer fully integrated revenue generation solutions;

 

-                    Address the growing complexity of managing multiple customer communication channels, including voice, self service, email, chat and text;

 

-                    Take advantage of cost efficiencies through the adoption of cloud-based or managed technology solutions;

 

-                   Consolidate outsourcing partners with those that have a solid financial position, adequate capital resources to sustain a long-term relationship and globally diverse delivery capabilities across a broad range of solutions; and

 

-                    Take advantage of cost efficiencies through the adoption of cloud-based technology solutions.

 

·                  Deepen and broaden existing client relationships;

 

·                 Continue to diversify revenue into higher-margin offerings such as professional services, revenue generation, talent acquisition, learning innovation services and our managed technology offerings;

 

·                  Win business with new clients and focus on end-to-end offerings in targeted industries, such as healthcare, retail and financial services, where we expect accelerating adoption of customer experience management;

 

·                  Continue to invest in innovative proprietary technology and new business offerings;

 

·                  Improve our operating margins through selective profit improvement initiatives;

 

·                  Increase asset utilization of our globally diverse delivery centers by providing services during non-peak hours with minimal incremental investment;

 

·                  Scale our work-from-home offering to increase operational flexibility; and

 

·                  Selectively pursue acquisitions that extend our capabilities, geographic reach and/or industry expertise.

 

As we further develop and continue to scale our strategic business units, we are continually evaluating ways to maximize shareholder value, which may include the disposition of business units, in whole or in part, that could take the form of asset sales, mergers, sales of equity interests in our subsidiaries (privately or through a public offering) or the spin-off of equity interests of our subsidiaries to our shareholders.

 

28



 

Our 2011 Financial Results

 

In 2011, our revenue increased 7.7% to $1,179 million over the 2010 year, which included an increase of 2.2% or $23.6 million due to fluctuations in foreign currency rates. This revenue increase was due to an increase in existing client programs, the addition of 41 new clients, and the 2010 acquisition of Peppers & Rogers Group and the 2011 acquisition of eLoyalty Corporation. Our income from operations increased 26.7% to $93.5 million or 7.9% of revenue in 2011 from $73.7 million or 6.7% of revenue in 2010. Income from operations in 2011 included $3.7 million and $0.2 million of restructuring charges and asset impairments, respectively.

 

Our offshore delivery centers serve clients based both in North America and in other countries. Our offshore delivery capacity spans five countries with 22,300 workstations and currently represents 70% of our global delivery capabilities. Revenue from services provided in these offshore locations was $517.8 million and represented 47% of our total revenue for 2011, excluding revenue from the two acquisitions, as compared to $492.6 million and 45% of our total revenue for 2010.

 

Our cash flow from operations allowed us to finance a significant portion of our capital needs and stock repurchases through internally generated cash flows. At December 31, 2011, we had $156.4 million of cash and cash equivalents, total debt of $66.4 million, and a total debt to total capitalization ratio of 12.4%. During 2011, we repurchased 3.4 million shares of our common stock for $63.7 million under the stock repurchase program. Since inception of the program through December 31, 2011, the Board has authorized the repurchase of shares up to an aggregate value of $462.3 million, of which we have purchased 32.2 million shares for $430.6 million. As of December 31, 2011, we held 31.0% of our outstanding shares of common stock in treasury.

 

Business Overview

 

Our business provides customer experience strategy, technology and business process outsourcing solutions for a variety of industries through our global delivery centers. Our North American BPO segment is comprised of sales to all clients based in North America (encompassing the U.S. and Canada), while our International BPO segment is comprised of sales to all clients based in all countries outside of North America.

 

See Note 3 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for additional discussion regarding the preparation of our segment information.

 

BPO Services

 

The BPO business generates revenue based primarily on the amount of time our associates or consultants devote to a client’s program. We primarily focus on large global corporations in the following industries: automotive, broadband, cable, financial services, government, healthcare, logistics, media and entertainment, retail, technology, travel, and wireline and wireless telecommunications. Revenue is recognized as services are provided. The majority of our revenue is from multi-year contracts and we expect this trend to continue. However, we do provide certain client programs on a short-term basis.

 

We have historically experienced annual attrition of existing client programs of approximately 5% to 12% of our revenue. Attrition of existing client programs during 2011 and 2010 was 5% and 10%, respectively.

 

The BPO industry is highly competitive. We compete primarily with the in-house business processing operations of our current and potential clients. We also compete with certain third-party BPO providers. Our ability to sell our existing services or gain acceptance for new products or services is challenged by the competitive nature of the industry. There can be no assurance that we will be able to sell services to new clients, renew relationships with existing clients, or gain client acceptance of our new products.

 

Our ability to renew or enter into new multi-year contracts, particularly large complex opportunities, is dependent upon the macroeconomic environment in general and the specific industry environments in which our clients operate. A continued weakening of the U.S. or the global economy could lengthen sales cycles or cause delays in closing new business opportunities.

 

29



 

Our potential clients typically obtain bids from multiple vendors and evaluate many factors in selecting a service provider, including, among others, the scope of services offered, the service record of the vendor and price. We generally price our bids with a long-term view of profitability and, accordingly, we consider all of our fixed and variable costs in developing our bids. We believe that our competitors, at times, may bid business based upon a short-term view, as opposed to our longer-term view, resulting in a lower price bid. While we believe our clients’ perceptions of the value we provide results in our being successful in certain competitive bid situations, there are often situations where a potential client may prefer a lower cost.

 

Our industry is labor-intensive and the majority of our operating costs relate to wages, employee benefits and employment taxes. An improvement in the local or global economies where our delivery centers are located could lead to increased labor-related costs. In addition, our industry experiences high personnel turnover, and the length of training time required to implement new programs continues to increase due to increased complexities of our clients’ businesses. This may create challenges if we obtain several significant new clients or implement several new, large scale programs and need to recruit, hire and train qualified personnel at an accelerated rate.

 

We may have difficulties managing the timeliness of launching new or expanded client programs and the associated internal allocation of personnel and resources. This could cause slower than anticipated revenue growth and/or higher than expected costs primarily related to hiring, training and retaining the required workforce, either of which could adversely affect our operating results.

 

Quarterly, we review our capacity utilization and projected demand for future capacity. In conjunction with these reviews, we may decide to consolidate or close under-performing delivery centers, including those impacted by the loss of a client program, in order to maintain or improve targeted utilization and margins. In addition, because clients may request that we serve their customers from international delivery centers with lower prevailing labor rates, in the future we may decide to close one or more of our delivery centers, even though it is generating positive cash flow, because we believe the future profits from conducting such work outside the current delivery center may more than compensate for the one-time charges related to closing the facility.

 

Our profitability is influenced by our ability to increase capacity utilization in our delivery centers. We attempt to minimize the financial impact resulting from idle capacity when planning the development and opening of new delivery centers or the expansion of existing delivery centers. As such, management considers numerous factors that affect capacity utilization, including anticipated expirations, reductions, terminations, or expansions of existing programs and the potential size and timing of new client contracts that we expect to obtain.

 

We continue to win new business with both new and existing clients. To respond more rapidly to changing market demands, to implement new programs and to expand existing programs, we may be required to commit to additional capacity prior to the contracting of additional business, which may result in idle capacity. This is largely due to the significant time required to negotiate and execute large, complex BPO client contracts and the difficulty of predicting specifically when new programs will launch.

 

30



 

We internally target capacity utilization in our delivery centers at 80% to 90% of our available workstations. As of December 31, 2011, the overall capacity utilization in our multi-client centers was 72%. The table below presents workstation data for our multi-client centers as of December 31, 2011 and 2010. Dedicated and Managed Centers (2,761 and 3,125 workstations, at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively) are excluded from the workstation data as unused workstations in these facilities are not available for sale. Our utilization percentage is defined as the total number of utilized production workstations compared to the total number of available production workstations. We may change the designation of shared or dedicated centers based on the normal changes in our business environment and client needs.

 

 

 

December 31, 2011

 

December 31, 2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total
Production
Workstations

 

In Use

 

% In
Use

 

Total
Production
Workstations

 

In Use

 

% In
Use

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Multi-client centers

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Sites open >1 year

 

27,443

 

20,449

 

75%

 

29,011

 

20,375

 

70%

 

Sites open <1 year

 

1,604

 

327

 

20%

 

792

 

509

 

64%

 

Total multi-client centers

 

29,047

 

20,776

 

72%

 

29,803

 

20,884

 

70%

 

 

We continue to see demand from all geographic regions to utilize our offshore delivery capabilities and expect this trend to continue with our clients. In light of this trend, we plan to continue to selectively retain capacity and expand into new offshore markets. As we grow our offshore delivery capabilities and our exposure to foreign currency fluctuations increase, we continue to actively manage this risk via a multi-currency hedging program designed to minimize operating margin volatility.

 

Critical Accounting Policies and Estimates

 

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of its financial condition and results of operations are based upon our Consolidated Financial Statements, which have been prepared in accordance with GAAP. The preparation of these financial statements requires us to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets, liabilities, revenue and expenses as well as the disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities. We regularly review our estimates and assumptions. These estimates and assumptions, which are based upon historical experience and on various other factors believed to be reasonable under the circumstances, form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities that are not readily apparent from other sources. Reported amounts and disclosures may have been different had management used different estimates and assumptions or if different conditions had occurred in the periods presented. Below is a discussion of the policies that we believe may involve a high degree of judgment and complexity.

 

Revenue Recognition

 

We recognize revenue when evidence of an arrangement exists, the delivery of service has occurred, the fee is fixed or determinable and collection is reasonably assured. The BPO inbound and outbound service fees are based on either a per minute, per hour, per transaction or per call basis. Certain client programs provide for adjustments to monthly billings based upon whether we achieve, exceed or fail certain performance criteria. Adjustments to monthly billings consist of contractual bonuses/penalties, holdbacks and other performance based contingencies. Revenue recognition is limited to the amount that is not contingent upon delivery of future services or meeting other specified performance conditions.

 

31



 

Revenue also consists of services for agent training, program launch, professional consulting, fully-hosted or managed technology and learning innovation services. These service offerings may contain multiple element arrangements whereby we determine if those service offerings represent separate units of accounting. A deliverable constitutes a separate unit of accounting when it has standalone value, and where return rights exist, delivery or performance of the undelivered items is considered probable and substantially within our control. If those deliverables are determined to be separate units of accounting, revenue is recognized as services are provided. If those deliverables are not determined to be separate units of accounting, revenue for the delivered services are bundled into one unit of accounting and recognized over the life of the arrangement or at the time all services and deliverables have been delivered and satisfied. We allocate revenue to each of the deliverables based on a selling price hierarchy of vendor specific objective evidence (“VSOE”), third-party evidence, and then estimated selling price. VSOE is based on the price charged when the deliverable is sold separately. Third-party evidence is based on largely interchangeable competitor services in standalone sales to similarly situated customers. Estimated selling price is based on our best estimate of what the selling prices of deliverables would be if they were sold regularly on a standalone basis. Estimated selling price is established considering multiple factors including, but not limited to, pricing practices in different geographies, service offerings, and customer classifications. Once we allocate revenue to each deliverable, we recognize revenue when all revenue recognition criteria are met.

 

Periodically, we will make certain expenditures related to acquiring contracts or provide up-front discounts for future services. These expenditures are capitalized as Contract Acquisition Costs and amortized in proportion to the expected future revenue from the contract, which in most cases results in straight-line amortization over the life of the contract. Amortization of these costs is recorded as a reduction to revenue.

 

Income Taxes

 

Accounting for income taxes requires recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities for the expected future income tax consequences of transactions that have been included in the Consolidated Financial Statements or tax returns. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on the difference between the financial statement and tax basis of assets and liabilities using tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. When circumstances warrant, we assess the likelihood that our net deferred tax assets will more likely than not be recovered from future projected taxable income.

 

We continually review the likelihood that deferred tax assets will be realized in future tax periods under the “more-likely-than-not” criteria. In making this judgment, we consider all available evidence, both positive and negative, in determining whether, based on the weight of that evidence, a valuation allowance is required.

 

We follow a two-step approach to recognizing and measuring uncertain tax positions. The first step is to determine if the weight of available evidence indicates that it is more likely than not that the tax position will be sustained on audit. The second step is to estimate and measure the tax benefit as the amount that has a greater than 50% likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement with the tax authority. We evaluate these uncertain tax positions on a quarterly basis. This evaluation is based on the consideration of several factors including changes in facts or circumstances, changes in applicable tax law, and settlement of issues under audit.

 

Interest and penalties relating to income taxes and uncertain tax positions are accrued net of tax in Provision for income taxes in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income.

 

32



 

In the future, our effective tax rate could be adversely affected by several factors, many of which are outside our control. Our effective tax rate is affected by the proportion of revenue and income before taxes in the various domestic and international jurisdictions in which we operate. Further, we are subject to changing tax laws, regulations and interpretations in multiple jurisdictions, in which we operate, as well as the requirements, pronouncements and rulings of certain tax, regulatory and accounting organizations. We estimate our annual effective tax rate each quarter based on a combination of actual and forecasted results of subsequent quarters. Consequently, significant changes in our actual quarterly or forecasted results may impact the effective tax rate for the current or future periods.

 

Allowance for Doubtful Accounts

 

We have established an allowance for doubtful accounts to reserve for uncollectible accounts receivable. Each quarter, management reviews the receivables on an account-by-account basis and assigns a probability of collection. Management’s judgment is used in assessing the probability of collection. Factors considered in making this judgment include, among other things, the age of the identified receivable, client financial condition, previous client payment history and any recent communications with the client.

 

Impairment of Long-Lived Assets

 

We evaluate the carrying value of property, plant and equipment and definite-lived intangible assets for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. An asset is considered to be impaired when the forecasted undiscounted cash flows of an asset group are estimated to be less than its carrying value. The amount of impairment recognized is the difference between the carrying value of the asset group and its fair value. Fair value estimates are based on assumptions concerning the amount and timing of estimated future cash flows and assumed discount rates.

 

Goodwill and Indefinite-Lived Intangible Assets

 

We evaluate goodwill and indefinite-lived intangible assets for possible impairment at least annually or whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of such assets may not be recoverable. An intangible asset with an indefinite life (a trade name) is evaluated for possible impairment by comparing the fair value of the asset with its carrying value. Fair value is estimated as the discounted value of future revenues arising from a trade name using a royalty rate that an independent party would pay for use of that trade name. An impairment charge is recorded if the trade name’s carrying value exceeds its estimated fair value.

 

We use a three step process to assess the realizability of goodwill based on recently adopted accounting guidance. The first step, Step 0, is a qualitative assessment that analyzes current economic indicators associated with a particular reporting unit. For example, we analyze changes in economic, market and industry conditions, business strategy, cost factors, and financial performance, among others, to determine if there would be a significant decline to the fair value of a particular reporting unit. A qualitative assessment also includes analyzing the excess fair value of a reporting unit over its carrying value from impairment assessments performed in previous years. If the qualitative assessment indicates a stable or improved fair value, no further testing is required.

 

If a qualitative assessment indicates that a significant decline to fair value of a reporting unit is more likely than not, or if a reporting unit’s fair value has historically been closer to its carrying value, we will proceed to Step 1 testing where we calculate the fair value of a reporting unit based on discounted future probability-weighted cash flows. If Step 1 indicates that the carrying value of a reporting unit is in excess of its fair value, we will proceed to Step 2 where the fair value of the reporting unit will be allocated to assets and liabilities as they would in a business combination. Impairment occurs when the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds its estimated fair value calculated in Step 2.

 

33



 

We estimate fair value using discounted cash flows of the reporting units. The most significant assumptions used in these analyses are those made in estimating future cash flows. In estimating future cash flows, we use financial assumptions in our internal forecasting model such as projected capacity utilization, projected changes in the prices we charge for our services, projected labor costs, as well as contract negotiation status. The financial and credit market volatility directly impacts our fair value measurement through our weighted average cost of capital that we use to determine our discount rate. We use a discount rate we consider appropriate for the country where the business unit is providing services. As of December 31, 2011, the Company’s assessment of goodwill impairment indicated that the fair values of the Company’s reporting units were substantially in excess of their estimated carrying values, and therefore goodwill in the reporting units was not impaired. If actual results are less than the assumptions used in performing the impairment test, the fair value of the reporting units may be significantly lower, causing the carrying value to exceed the fair value and indicating an impairment has occurred.

 

Restructuring Liability

 

We routinely assess the profitability and utilization of our delivery centers and existing markets. In some cases, we have chosen to close under-performing delivery centers and complete reductions in workforce to enhance future profitability. Severance payments that occur from reductions in workforce are in accordance with postemployment plans and/or statutory requirements that are communicated to all employees upon hire date; therefore, we recognize severance liabilities when they are determined to be probable and reasonably estimable. Other liabilities for costs associated with an exit or disposal activity are recognized when the liability is incurred, rather than upon commitment to a plan.

 

A significant assumption used in determining the amount of the estimated liability for closing delivery centers is the estimated liability for future lease payments on vacant centers, which we determine based on our ability to successfully negotiate early termination agreements with landlords and/or our ability to sublease the facility. If our assumptions regarding early termination and the timing and amounts of sublease payments prove to be inaccurate, we may be required to record additional losses, or conversely, a reversal of previously reported losses.

 

Equity-Based Compensation Expense

 

Equity-based compensation expense for all share-based payment awards granted is determined based on the grant-date fair value. We recognize equity-based compensation expense net of an estimated forfeiture rate, and recognize compensation expense only for shares that are expected to vest on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period of the award, which is typically the vesting term of the share-based payment award. We estimate the forfeiture rate annually based on historical experience of forfeited awards.

 

Fair Value Measurement

 

We determine the fair value of our various assets and liabilities based on a framework which measures fair value. The framework requires fair value to be determined based on the exchange price that would be received for an asset or paid to transfer a liability (an exit price) in the principal or most advantageous market for the asset or liability in an orderly transaction between market participants. We utilize market data or assumptions that we believe market participants would use in pricing the asset or liability, assumptions about counterparty credit risk, including the ability of each party to execute its obligation under the contract, and the risks inherent in the inputs to the valuation technique. These inputs can be readily observable, market corroborated or generally unobservable.

 

We primarily apply the market approach for recurring fair value measurements and endeavor to utilize the best available information. Accordingly, we utilize valuation techniques that maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs. We are able to classify fair value balances based on the observability of those inputs.

 

34



 

The valuation techniques required by the new provisions establish a fair value hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs used to measure fair value. The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (Level 1 measurement) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (Level 3 measurement). The three levels of the fair value hierarchy are as follows:

 

Level 1

Quoted prices are available in active markets for identical assets or liabilities as of the reporting date. Active markets are those in which transactions for the asset or liability occur in sufficient frequency and volume to provide pricing information on an ongoing basis. Level 1 primarily consists of financial instruments such as exchange-traded derivatives, listed equities and U.S. government treasury securities.

 

Level 2

Pricing inputs are other than quoted prices in active markets included in Level 1, which are either directly or indirectly observable as of the reporting date. Level 2 includes those financial instruments that are valued using models or other valuation methodologies. These models are primarily industry-standard models that consider various assumptions, including quoted forward prices for commodities, time value, volatility factors, and current market and contractual prices for the underlying instruments, as well as other relevant economic measures. Substantially all of these assumptions are observable in the marketplace throughout the full term of the instrument, can be derived from observable data or are supported by observable levels at which transactions are executed in the marketplace. Instruments in this category include non-exchange-traded derivatives such as over-the-counter forwards, options and repurchase agreements.

 

Level 3

Pricing inputs include significant inputs that are generally less observable from objective sources. These inputs may be used with internally developed methodologies that result in management’s best estimate of fair value from the perspective of a market participant. Level 3 instruments include those that may be more structured or otherwise tailored to customers’ needs. At each balance sheet date, we perform an analysis of all instruments subject to fair value measurements and include in Level 3 all of those whose fair value is based on significant unobservable inputs.

 

Derivatives

 

We enter into foreign exchange forward and option contracts to reduce our exposure to foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations that are associated with forecasted revenue in non-functional currencies. We enter into interest rate swaps to reduce our exposure to interest rate fluctuations on our variable rate debt.  Upon proper qualification, these contracts are accounted for as cash flow hedges under current accounting standards.  From time-to-time, we also enter into foreign exchange forward contracts to hedge our net investment in a foreign operation.

 

All derivative financial instruments are reported in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets at fair value. Changes in fair value of derivative instruments designated as cash flow hedges are recorded in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), a component of Stockholders’ Equity, to the extent they are deemed effective. Based on the criteria established by current accounting standards, all of our cash flow hedge contracts are deemed to be highly effective. Changes in fair value of any net investment hedge are recorded in cumulative translation adjustment in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets offsetting the change in cumulative translation adjustment attributable to the hedged portion of our net investment in the foreign operation. Any realized gains or losses resulting from the foreign currency cash flow hedges are recognized together with the hedged transactions within Revenue. Any realized gains or losses resulting from the interest rate swaps are recognized in interest income(expense).  Gains and losses from the settlements of our net investment hedge remain in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) until partial or complete liquidation of the applicable net investment.

 

35



 

We also enter into fair value derivative contracts to reduce our exposure to foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations associated with changes in asset and liability balances. Changes in the fair value of derivative instruments designated as fair value hedges affect the carrying value of the asset or liability hedged, with changes in both the derivative instrument and the hedged asset or liability being recognized in Other income (expense), net in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income.

 

While we expect that our derivative instruments will continue to be highly effective and in compliance with applicable accounting standards, if our hedges did not qualify as highly effective or if we determine that forecasted transactions will not occur, the changes in the fair value of the derivatives used as hedges would be reflected currently in earnings.

 

Contingencies

 

We record a liability for pending litigation and claims where losses are both probable and reasonably estimable. Each quarter, management reviews all litigation and claims on a case-by-case basis and assigns probability of loss and range of loss.

 

Explanation of Key Metrics and Other Items

 

Cost of Services

 

Cost of services principally include costs incurred in connection with our BPO operations, including direct labor, telecommunications, technology costs, printing, postage, sales and use tax and certain fixed costs associated with the delivery centers. In addition, cost of services includes income related to grants we may receive from local or state governments as an incentive to locate delivery centers in their jurisdictions which reduce the cost of services for those facilities.

 

Selling, General and Administrative

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses primarily include costs associated with administrative services such as sales, marketing, product development, legal settlements, legal, information systems (including core technology and telephony infrastructure) and accounting and finance. It also includes equity-based compensation expense, outside professional fees (i.e., legal and accounting services), building expense for non-delivery center facilities and other items associated with general business administration.

 

Restructuring Charges, Net

 

Restructuring charges, net primarily include costs incurred in conjunction with reductions in force or decisions to exit facilities, including termination benefits and lease liabilities, net of expected sublease rentals.

 

Interest Expense

 

Interest expense includes interest expense and amortization of debt issuance costs associated with our debts and capitalized lease obligations.

 

Other Income

 

The main components of other income are miscellaneous income not directly related to our operating activities, such as foreign exchange transaction gains.

 

Other Expenses

 

The main components of other expenses are expenditures not directly related to our operating activities, such as foreign exchange transaction losses.

 

36



 

Presentation of Non-GAAP Measurements

 

Free Cash Flow

 

Free cash flow is a non-GAAP liquidity measurement. We believe that free cash flow is useful to our investors because it measures, during a given period, the amount of cash generated that is available for debt obligations and investments other than purchases of property, plant and equipment. Free cash flow is not a measure determined by GAAP and should not be considered a substitute for “income from operations,” “net income,” “net cash provided by operating activities,” or any other measure determined in accordance with GAAP. We believe this non-GAAP liquidity measure is useful, in addition to the most directly comparable GAAP measure of “net cash provided by operating activities,” because free cash flow includes investments in operational assets. Free cash flow does not represent residual cash available for discretionary expenditures, since it includes cash required for debt service. Free cash flow also includes cash that may be necessary for acquisitions, investments and other needs that may arise.

 

The following table reconciles net cash provided by operating activities to free cash flow for our consolidated results (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

Net cash provided by operating activities

 

$

113,799

 

$

134,455

 

$

160,672

 

Less: Purchases of property, plant and equipment

 

38,310

(1)

26,800

 

24,188

(1)

Free cash flow

 

$

75,489

 

$

107,655

 

$

136,484

 

 

(1)      Purchases of property, plant and equipment for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009 are net of proceeds from a government grant of $0.4 million, zero, and $0.8 million, respectively.

 

We discuss factors affecting free cash flow between periods in the “Liquidity and Capital Resources” section below.

 

37



 

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 

Year Ended December 31, 2011 Compared to December 31, 2010

 

The following tables are presented to facilitate Management’s Discussion and Analysis. The following table presents results of operations by segment for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 (dollar amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2011

 

% of Revenue

 

2010

 

% of Revenue

 

$ Change

 

% Change

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

832,414

 

 

 

$

824,265

 

 

 

$

8,149

 

1.0%

 

International BPO

 

346,974

 

 

 

270,641

 

 

 

76,333

 

28.2%

 

 

 

$

1,179,388

 

 

 

$

1,094,906

 

 

 

$

84,482

 

7.7%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cost of services

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

586,808

 

70.5%

 

$

572,413

 

69.4%

 

$

14,395

 

2.5%

 

International BPO

 

261,554

 

75.4%

 

217,284

 

80.3%

 

44,270

 

20.4%

 

 

 

$

848,362

 

71.9%

 

$

789,697

 

72.1%

 

$

58,665

 

7.4%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling, general and administrative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

127,244

 

15.3%

 

$

119,845

 

14.5%

 

$

7,399

 

6.2%

 

International BPO

 

61,558

 

17.7%

 

45,967

 

17.0%

 

15,591

 

33.9%

 

 

 

$

188,802

 

16.0%

 

$

165,812

 

15.1%

 

$

22,990

 

13.9%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

33,347

 

4.0%

 

$

38,652

 

4.7%

 

$

(5,305)

 

-13.7%

 

International BPO

 

11,542

 

3.3%

 

11,566

 

4.3%

 

(24)

 

-0.2%

 

 

 

$

44,889

 

3.8%

 

$

50,218

 

4.6%

 

$

(5,329)

 

-10.6%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Restructuring charges, net

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

2,358

 

0.3%

 

$

8,206

 

1.0%

 

$

(5,848)

 

-71.3%

 

International BPO

 

1,293

 

0.4%

 

5,270

 

1.9%

 

(3,977)

 

-75.5%

 

 

 

$

3,651

 

0.3%

 

$

13,476

 

1.2%

 

$

(9,825)

 

-72.9%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Impairment losses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

(38)

 

0.0%

 

$

1,387

 

0.2%

 

$

(1,425)

 

-102.7%

 

International BPO

 

268

 

0.1%

 

571

 

0.2%

 

(303)

 

-53.1%

 

 

 

$

230

 

0.0%

 

$

1,958

 

0.2%

 

$

(1,728)

 

-88.3%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

82,695

 

9.9%

 

$

83,762

 

10.2%

 

$

(1,067)

 

-1.3%

 

International BPO

 

10,759

 

3.1%

 

(10,017)

 

-3.7%

 

20,776

 

207.4%

 

 

 

$

93,454

 

7.9%

 

$

73,745

 

6.7%

 

$

19,709

 

26.7%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other income (expense), net

 

$

(1,900)

 

-0.2%

 

$

8,224

 

0.8%

 

$

(10,124)

 

-123.1%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for income taxes

 

$

(13,279)

 

-1.1%

 

$

(28,431)

 

-2.6%

 

$

15,152

 

53.3%

 

 

38



 

Revenue

 

Revenue for the North American BPO segment for 2011 compared to 2010 was $832.4 million and $824.3 million, respectively. The increase in revenue for the North American BPO segment was due to a net increase of $137.3 million related to increases in client programs and the acquisition of eLoyalty, and a $1.7 million increase due to realized gains on cash flow hedges and positive changes in foreign currency translation, offset by a net decrease in short-term government programs of $80.0 million along with program completions of $50.9 million.

 

Revenue for the International BPO segment for 2011 compared to 2010 was $347.0 million and $270.6 million, respectively. The increase in revenue for the International BPO segment was due to a net increase of $58.0 million related to increases in client programs and the acquisition of Peppers & Rogers Group (“PRG”), and positive changes in foreign exchange translation of $21.9 million, offset by program completions of $3.5 million.

 

Our offshore delivery capacity represented 70% of our global delivery capabilities at December 31, 2011. Revenue from services provided in these offshore locations was $517.8 million and represented 47% of our revenue for 2011, excluding revenue from the two acquisitions, as compared to $492.6 million or 45% of revenue for 2010.

 

Cost of Services

 

Cost of services for the North American BPO segment for 2011 compared to 2010 was $586.8 million and $572.4 million, respectively. Cost of services as a percentage of revenue in the North American BPO segment increased compared to the prior year. In absolute dollars the increase was due to a $15.9 million increase in technology costs primarily related to the acquisition of eLoyalty, and a $11.6 million increase in employee related expenses due to increase volumes in existing programs and the acquisition of eLoyalty offset partially by a net decrease in short-term government programs and other program completions. This increase was partially offset by a $6.6 million decrease in telecommunications expenses primarily associated with a short-term government program that ended in 2010, a $1.9 million decrease in deferred training costs, a $0.9 million decrease for facility and occupancy expenses and a $3.7 million net decrease in other expenses.

 

Cost of services for the International BPO segment for 2011 compared to 2010 was $261.6 million and $217.3 million, respectively. Cost of services as a percentage of revenue in the International BPO segment decreased compared to the prior year. In absolute dollars the increase was due to a $42.9 million increase in employee related expenses due to a net increase in existing client volumes, new programs and the acquisition of PRG, a $2.6 million increase in facilities and occupancy expenses, offset by a $1.2 million net decrease in other expenses.

 

Selling, General and Administrative

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses for the North American BPO segment for 2011 compared to 2010 were $127.2 million and $119.8 million, respectively. The expenses increased in both absolute dollars and as a percentage of revenue. The increase in absolute dollars reflected an increase in employee related expenses of $12.7 million due to an increase in salaries, incentive and equity compensation and the acquisition of eLoyalty. This increase is offset in part by a $1.5 million decrease in telecommunication expenses, a $0.8 million decrease in insurance expenses, a $0.8 million decrease in external professional fees, and a $2.2 million net decrease in other expenses.

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses for the International BPO segment for 2011 compared to 2010 were $61.6 million and $46.0 million, respectively. The expenses increased in both absolute dollars and as a percentage of revenue. The increase in absolute dollars reflected an increase in employee related expenses of $15.2 million due to an increase in salaries, incentives and equity compensation expense and the acquisition of PRG, and a $0.4 million net increase in other expenses.

 

39



 

Depreciation and Amortization

 

Depreciation and amortization expense on a consolidated basis for 2011 and 2010 was $44.9 million and $50.2 million, respectively. For the North American BPO segment, the depreciation expense decreased both in absolute value and as a percentage of revenue as compared to the prior year. This decrease in value was due to restructuring activities and delivery center closures which have better aligned our capacity to our operational needs, and asset impairments recorded during 2010 resulting in the reduction of long-lived assets utilized, thereby reducing depreciation expense. For the International BPO segment, depreciation expense remained constant in absolute value while decreasing as a percentage of revenue as compared to the prior year. This change in value was due to a decrease in capital expenditures, restructuring activities and delivery center closures which have better aligned our capacity to our operational needs, offset by increases related to additional amortization expense of customer relationships from the recent acquisition.

 

Restructuring Charges

 

During 2011, we recorded a net $3.7 million of restructuring charges compared to $13.5 million in 2010. During both 2011 and 2010, we undertook reductions in both our North American BPO and the International BPO segments to better align our capacity and workforce with the current business needs. In 2011, we recorded $3.6 million in severance related expenses, and $0.1 million in delivery center closure costs in both the North American BPO and the International BPO segments. During 2010, we recorded $13.1 million in severance related expenses and $0.4 million in delivery center closure costs in both the North American BPO and the International BPO segments.

 

Impairment Losses

 

During 2011, we recorded $0.2 million of impairment charges compared to $2.0 million of impairment charges in 2010. In both 2011 and 2010, these impairment charges related to the reduction of the net book value of certain leasehold improvements in both the North American BPO and the International BPO segments.

 

Other Income (Expense)

 

For 2011, interest income increased to $3.1 million from $2.1 million in 2010, primarily due to higher cash and cash equivalent balances. Interest expense increased to $5.1 million during 2011 from $3.2 million during 2010. This increase was due to a higher outstanding balance on our credit facility. Other income (expense) decreased during 2011 as a result of the 2010 settlement of a Newgen Results Corporation legal claim which resulted in a gain of $5.9 million in 2010 (see Note 23 to the accompanying Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements).

 

Income Taxes

 

The effective tax rate for 2011 was 14.5% as compared to an effective tax rate of 34.7% in 2010. The 2011 effective tax rate was negatively influenced by an adverse decision by the Canada Revenue Agency regarding the Company’s request for relief from double taxation, and benefitted from a mediated settlement with the IRS related to U.S. tax refund claims, a reduction in the incremental U.S. tax expense (versus the estimate recorded in the fourth quarter of 2010) related to the Company’s 2010 repatriation of $105 million of foreign earnings, earnings reported in international jurisdictions currently under an income tax holiday, and the distribution of income between the U.S. and international tax jurisdictions. Without the $8.7 million expense related to the adverse decision by the Canada Revenue Agency regarding the Company’s request for relief from double taxation, the $11.7 million benefit related to the Company’s mediated settlement with the IRS related to U.S. tax refund claims, the $1.4 million benefit related to the foreign earnings repatriation, and $0.3 million benefit for other discrete items recognized during the period, the Company’s effective tax rate for 2011 would have been 19.7%.

 

40



 

Year Ended December 31, 2010 Compared to 2009

 

The following table presents results of operations by segment for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009 (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2010

 

% of Revenue

 

2009

 

% of Revenue

 

$ Change

 

% Change

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

824,265

 

 

 

$

886,738

 

 

 

$

(62,473)

 

-7.0%

 

International BPO

 

270,641

 

 

 

281,177

 

 

 

(10,536)

 

-3.7%

 

 

 

$

1,094,906

 

 

 

$

1,167,915

 

 

 

$

(73,009)

 

-6.3%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cost of services

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

572,413

 

69.4%

 

$

598,040

 

67.4%

 

$

(25,627)

 

-4.3%

 

International BPO

 

217,284

 

80.3%

 

222,477

 

79.1%

 

(5,193)

 

-2.3%

 

 

 

$

789,697

 

72.1%

 

$

820,517

 

70.3%

 

$

(30,820)

 

-3.8%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Selling, general and administrative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

119,845

 

14.5%

 

$

132,399

 

14.9%

 

$

(12,554)

 

-9.5%

 

International BPO

 

45,967

 

17.0%

 

47,640

 

16.9%

 

(1,673)

 

-3.5%

 

 

 

$

165,812

 

15.1%

 

$

180,039

 

15.4%

 

$

(14,227)

 

-7.9%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

38,652

 

4.7%

 

$

39,603

 

4.5%

 

$

(951)

 

-2.4%

 

International BPO

 

11,566

 

4.3%

 

17,388

 

6.2%

 

(5,822)

 

-33.5%

 

 

 

$

50,218

 

4.6%

 

$

56,991

 

4.9%

 

$

(6,773)

 

-11.9%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Restructuring charges, net

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

8,206

 

1.0%

 

$

3,388

 

0.4%

 

$

4,818

 

142.2%

 

International BPO

 

5,270

 

1.9%

 

1,684

 

0.6%

 

3,586

 

212.9%

 

 

 

$

13,476

 

1.2%

 

$

5,072

 

0.4%

 

$

8,404

 

165.7%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Impairment losses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

1,387

 

0.2%

 

$

1,811

 

0.2%

 

$

(424)

 

-23.4%

 

International BPO

 

571

 

0.2%

 

2,776

 

1.0%

 

(2,205)

 

-79.4%

 

 

 

$

1,958

 

0.2%

 

$

4,587

 

0.4%

 

$

(2,629)

 

-57.3%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

83,762

 

10.2%

 

$

111,497

 

12.6%

 

$

(27,735)

 

-24.9%

 

International BPO

 

(10,017)

 

-3.7%

 

(10,788)

 

-3.8%

 

771

 

7.1%

 

 

 

$

73,745

 

6.7%

 

$

100,709

 

8.6%

 

$

(26,964)

 

-26.8%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other income (expense), net

 

$

8,224

 

0.8%

 

$

2,334

 

0.2%

 

$

5,890

 

252.4%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for income taxes

 

$

(28,431)

 

-2.6%

 

$

(27,477)

 

-2.4%

 

$

(954)

 

-3.5%

 

 

41



 

Revenue

 

Revenue for the North American BPO segment for 2010 compared to 2009 was $824.3 million and $886.7 million, respectively. The decrease in revenue for the North American BPO segment was due to program completions of $64.3 million, net decreases in client programs of $44.3 million, and a $2.0 million reduction to revenue for disputed service delivery issues. This was offset by net increases in short-term government programs of $16.9 million, and a $31.3 million increase due to realized gains on cash flow hedges and positive changes in foreign currency translation.

 

Revenue for the International BPO segment for 2010 compared to 2009 was $270.6 million and $281.2 million, respectively. The decrease in revenue for the International BPO segment was due to program completions of $28.8 million, offset by net increases in client programs of $6.2 million, and positive changes in foreign currency translation of $12.0 million.

 

Our offshore delivery capacity represented 72% of our global delivery capabilities at December 31, 2010. In 2010 revenue from services provided in these offshore locations was $492.6 million and represented 45% of our total revenue. In 2009 revenue from services provided in these offshore locations was $556.5 million and represented 48% of our total revenue. Factors that may impact our ability to maintain our offshore operating margins include potential increases in competition for the available workforce, the trend of higher occupancy costs and foreign currency fluctuations.

 

Cost of Services

 

Cost of services for the North American BPO segment for 2010 compared to 2009 was $572.4 million and $598.0 million, respectively. Cost of services as a percentage of revenue in the North American BPO segment increased compared to the prior year. In absolute dollars the decrease was due to a $35.3 million decrease in employee related expenses due to lower volumes in existing client programs and the completion of client programs, and a $3.0 million decrease in technology costs. This decrease was offset in part by a $4.2 million increase in telecommunications expenses primarily associated with a short-term government program, a $3.0 million decrease in training grant reimbursements, a $1.9 million increase for facility and occupancy expenses, a $1.1 million increase in contract labor, and a $2.5 million net increase in other expenses.

 

Cost of services for the International BPO segment for 2010 compared to 2009 was $217.3 million and $222.5 million, respectively. Cost of services as a percentage of revenue in the International BPO segment increased slightly compared to the prior year. In absolute dollars the decrease was due to a $2.8 million decrease in employee related expenses due to the migration of several clients from onshore delivery centers to offshore delivery centers, lower volumes for some client programs and the completion of client programs, a $0.8 million decrease in sales and use taxes, and a $2.5 million net decrease in other expenses, offset by a $0.9 million increase in facility and occupancy expenses.

 

Selling, General and Administrative

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses for the North American BPO segment for 2010 compared to 2009 were $119.8 million and $132.4 million, respectively. The expenses decreased in both absolute dollars and as a percentage of revenue. The decrease in absolute dollars was due to a $12.1 million decrease in employee expenses and incentive compensation expense, a $1.4 million decrease in bad debts, and a $1.0 million decrease in litigation settlements, offset by a $1.2 million net increase in other expenses, and a $0.7 million increase in corporate business insurance expense.

 

Selling, general and administrative expenses for the International BPO segment for 2010 compared to 2009 were $46.0 million and $47.6 million, respectively. The expenses decreased in absolute dollars while increasing slightly as a percentage of revenue. The decrease in absolute dollars was due to a decrease of $2.3 million for employee expenses and incentive compensation expense, a $1.3 million decrease in telecommunication expenses, and a $0.8 million decrease in facility and occupancy expenses, offset by a $1.3 million net increase in other expenses, a $0.9 million increase in litigation settlements, and a $0.6 million increase in bad debts.

 

42



 

Depreciation and Amortization

 

Depreciation and amortization expense on a consolidated basis for 2010 and 2009 was $50.2 million and $57.0 million, respectively. For the North American BPO segment, the depreciation expense decreased slightly in absolute value while it increased slightly as a percentage of revenue as compared to the prior year. For the International BPO segment, the depreciation expense decreased in absolute value and as a percentage of revenue as compared to the prior year. This decrease in value was due to a decrease in capital expenditures, restructuring activities and delivery center closures which have better aligned our capacity to our operational needs as well as asset impairments recorded during December 31, 2010 and 2009, resulting in the reduction of long-lived assets utilized, thereby reducing depreciation expense year over year.

 

Restructuring Charges

 

During 2010, we recorded a net $13.5 million of restructuring charges compared to $5.1 million in 2009. During 2010, we undertook reductions in both our North American BPO and International BPO segments to better align our capacity and workforce with the current business needs. We recorded $13.1 million in severance related expenses, and $0.4 million in delivery center closure costs in both the North American BPO and International BPO segments. During 2009, we recorded $5.5 million in severance related expenses and $0.6 million in delivery center closure costs in both the North American BPO and International BPO segments, and a $1.0 million reduction in our estimates of previously recorded delivery center closure charges in the North American BPO segment.

 

Impairment Losses

 

During 2010, we recorded $2.0 million of impairment charges compared to $4.6 million of impairment charges in 2009. In both 2010 and 2009, these impairment charges related to the reduction of the net book value of certain leasehold improvements in both the North American BPO and International BPO segments.

 

Other Income (Expense)

 

For 2010, interest income decreased to $2.1 million from $2.6 million in 2009, primarily due to lower cash and cash equivalent balances and lower interest rates. Interest expense remained relatively flat between 2010 and 2009 at $3.2 million. Other income increased during 2010 as a result of the 2010 settlement of a Newgen Results Corporation legal claim which resulted in a gain of $5.9 million (see Note 23 to the accompanying Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements).

 

Income Taxes

 

The effective tax rate for 2010 was 34.7%. This compared to an effective tax rate of 26.7% in 2009. The 2010 effective tax rate increased due to $5.6 million in incremental income taxes owed to the U.S. associated with our decision to repatriate $104.8 million in foreign earnings which had previously been considered permanently invested outside the United States. In addition, income taxes increased because we recorded a $2.5 million deferred tax liability in the U.S. related to foreign tax assets that will no longer be able to offset tax in more than one jurisdiction. Income taxes also increased due to a $6.6 million increase to the deferred tax valuation allowance, $3.7 million of this increase arising in the fourth quarter due to our change in judgment concerning the recoverability of tax assets in one European jurisdiction. Income taxes also increased by $2.3 million related to the $5.9 million gain recorded in Other income (expense), net as discussed above and $0.7 million of other charges. Offsetting these increases is a $4.0 million reduction to income taxes for foreign tax planning strategies associated with our international operations. Without these items our effective tax rate for 2010 would have been 19.3%.

 

43



 

Liquidity and Capital Resources

 

Our principal sources of liquidity are our cash generated from operations, our cash and cash equivalents, and borrowings under our Credit Agreement, dated October 1, 2010 (the “Credit Agreement”). During the year ended December 31, 2011, we generated positive operating cash flows of $113.8 million. We believe that our cash generated from operations, existing cash and cash equivalents, and available credit will be sufficient to meet expected operating and capital expenditure requirements for the next 12 months.

 

We manage a centralized global treasury function in the United States with a particular focus on concentrating and safeguarding our global cash and cash equivalents. While the majority of our cash resides offshore, we prefer to hold U.S. Dollars in addition to the local currencies of our foreign subsidiaries. We expect to use our offshore cash to support working capital and growth of our foreign operations. While there are no assurances, we believe our global cash is protected given our cash management practices, banking partners, and utilization of diversified, high quality investments.

 

We have global operations that expose us to foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations that may positively or negatively impact our liquidity. We are also exposed to higher interest rates associated with our variable rate debt. To mitigate these risks, we enter into foreign exchange forward and option contracts and interest rate swaps through our cash flow hedging program. Please refer to Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk, Foreign Currency Risk, for further discussion.

 

We primarily utilize our Credit Agreement to fund working capital, general operations, stock repurchases and other strategic activities, such as the acquisitions described in Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. As of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, we had borrowings of $64.0 million and zero, respectively, under our Credit Agreement, and the average daily utilization was $112.4 million and $62.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. After consideration for issued letters of credit under the Credit Agreement, totaling $4.5 million, our remaining borrowing capacity was $281.5 million as of December 31, 2011. As of December 31, 2011, we were in compliance with all covenants and conditions under our Credit Agreement.

 

The amount of capital required over the next 12 months will depend on our levels of investment in infrastructure necessary to maintain, upgrade or replace existing assets. Our working capital and capital expenditure requirements could also increase materially in the event of acquisitions or joint ventures, among other factors. These factors could require that we raise additional capital through future debt or equity financing. As an ongoing practice to provide additional financial flexibility to fund strategic activities, we are evaluating our capital resources and considering an increase in the commitments under our existing Credit Facility. Our decision to secure additional commitments will be largely based on market conditions, costs, and credit capacity from our bank syndicate. There can be no assurance that additional financing will be available, at all, or on terms favorable to us.

 

The following discussion highlights our cash flow activities during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009.

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents

 

We consider all liquid investments purchased within 90 days of their original maturity to be cash equivalents. Our cash and cash equivalents totaled $156.4 million and $119.4 million as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. We diversify the holdings of such cash and cash equivalents considering the financial condition and stability of the counterparty institutions.

 

44



 

Cash Flows from Operating Activities

 

We reinvest our cash flows from operating activities in our business for strategic acquisitions and for the purchase of our outstanding stock. For the years 2011, 2010 and 2009 we reported net cash flows provided by operating activities of $113.8 million, $134.5 million and $160.7 million, respectively. The net decrease from 2010 to 2011 was primarily due to a $36.2 million decrease in accounts payable and accrued expenses, which includes the payment of $24.3 million for income taxes, and a $5.7 million decrease in the collection of accounts receivable, offset by a $24.7 million increase in net income. The net decrease from 2009 to 2010 was primarily due to a $22.0 million decrease in net income, and a $27.3 million decrease in the collection of accounts receivable, offset by a $38.8 million increase in accounts payable and accrued expenses.

 

Cash Flows from Investing Activities

 

We reinvest cash in our business primarily to grow our client base and to expand our infrastructure. For the years 2011, 2010 and 2009, we reported net cash flows used in investing activities of $86.9 million, $43.2 million and $29.8 million, respectively. The net increase in cash used from investing activities from 2010 to 2011 was primarily due to the $38.0 million payment for the acquisition of eLoyalty, and a $11.9 million increase in net capital expenditures, offset by a $4.9 million decrease from the $12.8 million payment for the acquisition of Peppers & Rogers Group during 2010. The net increase in cash used from investing activities from 2009 to 2010 was primarily due to the $12.8 million payment for the acquisition of Peppers & Rogers Group, the payment of a $3.6 million Newgen Results Corporation legal claim settlement, and a $1.8 million increase in net capital expenditures, offset by a $3.9 million decrease in contract acquisition costs paid.

 

Cash Flows from Financing Activities

 

For the years 2011, 2010 and 2009, we reported net cash flows provided by (used in) financing activities of $15.9 million, $(85.9) million and $(114.9) million, respectively. The change from 2010 to 2011 was due to an increase in net borrowings on our line of credit of $64.0 million and a decrease in cash used to purchase common stock of $16.6 million. The change from 2009 to 2010 was due to a decrease in net payments on our line of credit of $80.8 million offset by an increase in cash used to purchase common stock of $45.5 million.

 

Free Cash Flow

 

Free cash flow (see “Presentation of Non-GAAP Measurements” for definition of free cash flow) was $75.5 million, $107.7 million and $136.5 million for the years 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. The decrease from 2010 to 2011 resulted primarily from the $20.7 million decrease in cash flow from operating activities, as previously discussed, and a $11.9 million increase in capital expenditures. The decrease from 2009 to 2010 resulted primarily from a significant decrease in cash flow from operating activities.

 

Obligations and Future Capital Requirements

 

Future maturities of our outstanding debt and contractual obligations as of December 31, 2011 are summarized as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

 

Less than 1
Year

 

 

1 to 3
Years

 

 

3 to 5
Years

 

 

Over 5
Years

 

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Credit Facility(1)

 

$

2,484

 

$

5,535

 

$

76,170

 

$

-

 

$

84,189

 

Capital lease obligations

 

366

 

-

 

 

-

 

 

-

 

366

 

Equipment financing arrangements

 

534

 

245

 

 

-

 

 

-

 

779

 

Purchase obligations

 

25,667

 

5,649

 

 

-

 

 

-

 

31,316

 

Operating lease commitments

 

24,731

 

35,236

 

 

10,532

 

 

5,729

 

76,228

 

Total

 

$

53,782

 

$

46,665

 

$

86,702

 

$

5,729

 

$

192,878

 

 

45



 

(1)

 

Includes estimated interest payments based on the weighted-average interest rate, current interest rate swap arrangements, and debt outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and unused commitment fees.

 

 

 

·

 

Contractual obligations to be paid in a foreign currency are translated at the period end exchange rate.

 

 

 

·

 

Purchase obligations primarily consist of outstanding purchase orders for goods or services not yet received, which are not recognized as liabilities in our Consolidated Balance Sheets until such goods and/or services are received.

 

 

 

·

 

The contractual obligation table excludes our liabilities of $3.3 million related to uncertain tax positions because we cannot reliably estimate the timing of future cash payments. See Note 11 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for further discussion.

 

 

 

·

 

The contractual obligations table excludes the contingent consideration arrangement associated with the PRG acquisition as we have estimated this liability to be zero at December 31, 2011 as described in Note 2 of the Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

Purchase Obligations

 

Occasionally we contract with certain of our communications clients to provide us with telecommunication services. These clients currently represent approximately 14% of our total annual revenue. We believe these contracts are negotiated on an arm’s-length basis and may be negotiated at different times and with different legal entities.

 

Future Capital Requirements

 

We expect total capital expenditures in 2012 to be consistent with prior year. Approximately 75% of these expected capital expenditures are to support growth in our business and 25% relates to the maintenance for existing assets. The anticipated level of 2012 capital expenditures is primarily dependent upon new client contracts and the corresponding requirements for additional delivery center capacity as well as enhancements to our technological infrastructure.

 

We may consider restructurings, dispositions, mergers, acquisitions and other similar transactions. Such transactions could include the transfer, sale or acquisition of significant assets, businesses or interests, including joint ventures or the incurrence, assumption, or refinancing of indebtedness and could be material to the consolidated financial condition and consolidated results of our operations. Our capital expenditures requirements could also increase materially in the event of acquisition or joint ventures. In May 2011 we acquired certain assets and assumed certain liabilities of a business unit of eLoyalty Corporation that provides consulting, system integration and the ongoing management and support of telephony, data, and converged Voice Over Internet Protocol customer management environments for $40.9 million net of certain closing adjustments. In addition, as of December 31, 2011, we were authorized to purchase an additional $31.7 million of common stock under our stock repurchase program (see Part II Item 5 of this Form 10-K). The stock repurchase program does not have an expiration date.

 

The launch of large client contracts may result in short-term negative working capital because of the time period between incurring the costs for training and launching the program and the beginning of the accounts receivable collection process. As a result, periodically we may generate negative cash flows from operating activities.

 

Debt Instruments and Related Covenants

 

On October 1, 2010, we entered into the Credit Agreement with a syndicate of lenders led by KeyBank National Association, Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, Bank of America, N.A., BBVA Compass, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A.

 

46



 

The Credit Agreement provides for a secured revolving credit facility that matures on September 30, 2015 with an initial maximum aggregate commitment of $350.0 million. At our discretion, direct borrowing options under the Credit Agreement include (i) Eurodollar loans with one, two, three, and six month terms, and/or (ii) overnight base rate loans. The Credit Agreement also provides for a sub-limit for loans or letters of credit in both U.S. Dollars and certain foreign currencies, with direct foreign subsidiary borrowing capabilities up to 50% of the total commitment amount. We may increase the maximum aggregate commitment under the Credit Agreement to $500.0 million if certain conditions are satisfied, including that we are not in default under the Credit Agreement at the time of the increase and that we obtain the commitment of the lenders participating in the increase.

 

Base rate loans bear interest at a rate equal to the greatest of (i) KeyBank National Association’s prime rate, (ii) the federal funds effective rate plus 0.5% or (iii) the one month London Interbank Offered Rate plus 1.25%, in each case adding a margin based upon our leverage ratio. Eurodollar and alternate currency loans bear interest based upon LIBOR, as adjusted for prescribed bank reserves, plus a margin based upon our leverage ratio. Letter of credit fees are 1.25% of the stated amount of the letter of credit on the date of issuance, renewal or amendment, plus an annual fee equal to the borrowing margin for Eurodollar loans. Facility fees are payable to the Lenders in an amount equal to the unused portion of the credit facility and are based upon our leverage ratio.

 

Indebtedness under the Credit Agreement is guaranteed by certain of our present and future domestic subsidiaries and is secured by security interests (subject to permitted liens) in the U.S. accounts receivable and cash of the Company and certain of our domestic subsidiaries and may be secured by tangible assets of the Company and such domestic subsidiaries if borrowings by foreign subsidiaries exceed $50.0 million and the leverage ratio is greater than 2.50 to 1.00. We also pledged 65% of the voting stock and 100% of the non-voting stock of certain of the Company’s material foreign subsidiaries and may pledge 65% of the voting stock and 100% of the non-voting stock of the Company’s other foreign subsidiaries.

 

The Credit Agreement, which includes customary financial covenants, may be used for general corporate purposes, including working capital, purchases of treasury stock and acquisition financing. As of December 31, 2011, we were in compliance with all financial covenants. During 2011, 2010 and 2009, borrowings accrued interest at an average rate of approximately 1.6%, 1.5%, and 1.2% per annum, respectively, excluding unused commitment fees. Our daily average borrowings during 2011, 2010 and 2009 were $112.4 million, $62.5 million and $74.3 million, respectively. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, we had borrowing outstanding of $64.0 million and zero, respectively, under the Credit Agreement.  Availability was $281.5 million as of December 31, 2011, reduced from $350.0 million by $4.5 million in issued letters of credit; and $345.4 million as of December 31, 2010, reduced by $4.6 million in issued letters of credit.

 

From time-to-time, we may have unsecured, uncommitted bank lines of credit to support working capital for a few foreign subsidiaries. As of December 31, 2011, we had no foreign loans outstanding.  As of December 31, 2010, we had only one loan outstanding for approximately $0.6 million, which is included in Other current liabilities in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets. The line of credit accrued interest at 6.0% per annum.

 

Client Concentration

 

Our five largest clients accounted for 37%, 39% and 36% of our annual revenue for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. We have experienced long-term relationships with our top five clients, ranging from five to 16 years, with the majority of these clients having completed multiple contract renewals with TeleTech. The relative contribution of any single client to consolidated earnings is not always proportional to the relative revenue contribution on a consolidated basis and varies greatly based upon specific contract terms. In addition, clients may adjust business volumes served by us based on their business requirements. We believe the risk of this concentration is mitigated, in part, by the long-term contracts we have with our largest clients. Although certain client contracts may be terminated for convenience by either party, we believe this risk is mitigated, in part, by the service level disruptions and transition/migration costs that would arise for our clients.

 

47



 

The contracts with our ten largest clients expire between 2012 and 2015. Additionally, a particular client may have multiple contracts with different expiration dates. We have historically renewed most of our contracts with our largest clients. However, there is no assurance that future contracts will be renewed or, if renewed, will be on terms as favorable as the existing contracts.

 

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements

 

We discuss the potential impact of recent accounting pronouncements in Note 1 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

ITEM 7A.  QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

 

Market risk represents the risk of loss that may impact our consolidated financial position, consolidated results of operations, or consolidated cash flows due to adverse changes in financial and commodity market prices and rates. Market risk also includes credit and non-performance risk by counterparties to our various financial instruments. We are exposed to market risks due to changes in interest rates and foreign currency exchange rates (as measured against the U.S. dollar); as well as credit risk associated with potential non-performance of our counterparty banks. These exposures are directly related to our normal operating and funding activities. We enter into derivative instruments to manage and reduce the impact of currency exchange rate changes, primarily between the U.S. dollar/Canadian dollar, the U.S. dollar/Philippine peso, the U.S. dollar/Mexican peso, and the Australian dollar/Philippine peso. We enter into interest rate derivative instruments to reduce our exposure to interest rate fluctuations associated with our variable rate debt. To mitigate against credit and non-performance risk, it is our policy to only enter into derivative contracts and other financial instruments with investment grade counterparty financial institutions and, correspondingly, our derivative valuations reflect the creditworthiness of our counterparties. As of the date of this report, we have not experienced, nor do we anticipate, any issue related to derivative counterparty defaults.

 

Interest Rate Risk

 

The interest rate on our Credit Agreement is variable based upon the Prime Rate and LIBOR and, therefore, is affected by changes in market interest rates. As of December 31, 2011, we had $64.0 million of outstanding borrowings under the Credit Agreement. Based upon average daily outstanding borrowings during the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, interest accrued at a rate of approximately 1.6% and 1.5% per annum, respectively. If the Prime Rate or LIBOR increased by 100 basis points during the quarter, there would not have been a material impact to our consolidated financial position or results of operations.

 

The Company’s interest rate swap arrangements as of December 31, 2011 were as follows:

 

 

 

Notional
Amount

 

Variable Rate
Received

 

Fixed Rate
Paid

 

Contract
Commencement
Date

 

Contract
Maturity
Date

As of December 31, 2011

 

$

25 million

 

1 - month LIBOR

 

2.55

%

 

April 2012

 

April 2016

 

 

 

15 million

 

1 - month LIBOR

 

3.14

%

 

May 2012

 

May 2017

 

 

$

40 million

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

We did not have any interest rate swap arrangements as of December 31, 2010.

 

Foreign Currency Risk

 

Our subsidiaries in Argentina, Canada, Costa Rica, Mexico, and the Philippines use the local currency as their functional currency for paying labor and other operating costs. Conversely, revenue for these foreign subsidiaries is derived principally from client contracts that are invoiced and collected in U.S. dollars or other foreign currencies. As a result, we may experience foreign currency gains or losses, which may positively or negatively affect our results of operations attributed to these subsidiaries. For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, revenue associated with this foreign exchange risk was 34%, 34% and 36% of our consolidated revenue, respectively.

 

48



 

The following summarizes relative (weakening) strengthening of local currencies:

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2011

2010

2009

 

 

 

 

 

Canadian Dollar vs. U.S. Dollar

 

(2.0)%

4.7%

14.3%

Philippine Peso vs. U.S. Dollar

 

(0.1)%

5.4%

2.2%

Argentina Peso vs. U.S. Dollar

 

(8.3)%

(4.1)%

(8.1)%

Mexican Peso vs. U.S. Dollar

 

(13.0)%

5.0%

5.7%

S. African Rand vs. U.S. Dollar

 

(22.5)%

10.4%

20.6%

Australian Dollar vs. U.S. Dollar

 

0.1%

12.1%

21.8%

Euro vs. U.S. Dollar

 

(2.3)%

(8.2)%

2.9%

Philippine Peso vs. Australian Dollar

 

(0.2)%

(7.6)%

(25.1)%

 

In order to mitigate the risk of these non-functional foreign currencies from weakening against the functional currencies of the servicing subsidiaries, which thereby decreases the economic benefit of performing work in these countries, we may hedge a portion, though not 100%, of the projected foreign currency exposure related to client programs served from these foreign countries through our cash flow hedging program. While our hedging strategy can protect us from adverse changes in foreign currency rates in the short term, an overall weakening of the non-functional foreign currencies would adversely impact margins in the segments of the contracting subsidiary over the long term.

 

Cash Flow Hedging Program

 

To reduce our exposure to foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations associated with forecasted revenue in non-functional currencies, we purchase forward and/or option contracts to acquire the functional currency of the foreign subsidiary at a fixed exchange rate at specific dates in the future. We have designated and account for these derivative instruments as cash flow hedges for forecasted revenue in non-functional currencies.

 

While we have implemented certain strategies to mitigate risks related to the impact of fluctuations in currency exchange rates, we cannot ensure that we will not recognize gains or losses from international transactions, as this is part of transacting business in an international environment. Not every exposure is or can be hedged and, where hedges are put in place based on expected foreign exchange exposure, they are based on forecasts for which actual results may differ from the original estimate. Failure to successfully hedge or anticipate currency risks properly could adversely affect our consolidated operating results.

 

Our cash flow hedging instruments as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 are summarized as follows (amounts in thousands). All hedging instruments are forward contracts, except as noted.

 

As of December 31, 2011

 

Local
Currency
Notional
Amount

 

U.S. Dollar
Notional
Amount

 

% Maturing
in 2012

 

Contracts
Maturing
Through

Canadian Dollar

 

25,750

 

$

25,137

 

69.9%

 

March 2014

Costa Rican Colon

 

2,000,000

 

 

3,874

 

100.0%

 

August 2012

Philippine Peso

 

13,304,000

 

 

301,361

(1)

56.3%

 

December 2014

Mexican Peso (Forwards)

 

1,081,000

 

 

80,735

 

47.7%

 

November 2014

Mexican Peso (Collars)

 

140,298

 

 

12,000

(3)

100.0%

 

December 2012

British Pound Sterling

 

8,808

 

 

13,822

(2)

60.1%

 

June 2014

 

 

 

 

$

436,929

 

 

 

 

 

49



 

As of December 31, 2010

 

Local
Currency
Notional
Amount

 

 

U.S. Dollar
Notional
Amount

 

 

 

 

Canadian Dollar

 

10,200

 

$

8,493

 

 

 

 

Philippine Peso

 

7,731,000

 

 

169,364

(1)

 

 

 

Mexican Peso

 

311,500

 

 

22,383

 

 

 

 

British Pound Sterling

 

4,647

 

 

7,231

(2)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

207,471

 

 

 

 

 

(1)

Includes contracts to purchase Philippine pesos in exchange for New Zealand dollars and Australian dollars, which are translated into equivalent U.S. dollars on December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.

(2)

Includes contracts to purchase British pound sterling in exchange for Euros, which are translated into equivalent U.S. dollars on December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.

(3)

The Mexican peso collars include call options with a floor total of MXN 140,298 and put options with a cap total of MXN 157,038.

 

 

The fair value of our cash flow hedges at December 31, 2011 was (assets/(liabilities)) (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

Maturing in

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2012

 

Canadian Dollar

 

$

10

 

 

$

(126)

 

Costa Rican Colon

 

 

89

 

 

 

89

 

Philippine Peso

 

 

(124)

 

 

 

(350)

 

Mexican Peso

 

 

(6,968)

 

 

 

(5,053)

 

British Pound Sterling

 

 

(177)

 

 

 

(63)

 

 

 

$

(7,170)

 

 

$

(5,503)

 

 

Our cash flow hedges are valued using models based on market observable inputs, including both forward and spot foreign exchange rates, implied volatility, and counterparty credit risk. The year over year decrease in fair value largely reflects the recent global economic conditions, which resulted in high foreign exchange volatility and a broad strengthening in the U.S. dollar in the second half of 2011.

 

We recorded net gains/(losses) of $9.3 million, $9.8 million, and $(18.3) million for settled cash flow hedge contracts and the related premiums for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009, respectively. These gains/(losses) were reflected in Revenue in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income. If the exchange rates between our various currency pairs were to increase or decrease by 10% from current period-end levels, we would incur a material gain or loss on the contracts. However, any gain or loss would be mitigated by corresponding increases or decreases in our underlying exposures.

 

Other than the transactions hedged as discussed above and in Note 9 in the accompanying Consolidated Financial Statements, the majority of the transactions of our U.S. and foreign operations are denominated in their respective local currency. However, transactions are denominated in other currencies from time-to-time. We do not currently engage in hedging activities related to these types of foreign currency risks because we believe them to be insignificant as we endeavor to settle these accounts on a timely basis. For the years ended 2011 and 2010, approximately 29% and 25%, respectively, of revenue was derived from contracts denominated in currencies other than the U.S. Dollar.  Our results from operations and revenue could be adversely affected if the U.S. Dollar strengthens significantly against foreign currencies.

 

Fair Value of Debt and Equity Securities

 

We did not have any investments in debt or equity securities as of December 31, 2011 or 2010.

 

50



 

ITEM 8.  FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND SUPPLEMENTARY DATA

 

The financial statements required by this item are located beginning on page F-1 of this report and incorporated herein by reference.

 

ITEM 9.  CHANGES IN AND DISAGREEMENTS WITH ACCOUNTANTS ON
ACCOUNTING AND FINANCIAL DISCLOSURE

 

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 9A.  CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

 

This Form 10-K includes the certifications of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer required by Rule 13a-14 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”). See Exhibits 31.1 and 31.2. This Item 9A includes information concerning the controls and control evaluations referred to in those certifications.

 

Disclosure Controls and Procedures.

 

Our management, with the participation of our CEO and CFO, has evaluated the effectiveness of TeleTech’s disclosure controls and procedures, as required by Rule 13a-15(b) and 15d-15(b) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”) as of December 31, 2011. Our disclosure controls and procedures are designed to reasonably assure that information required to be disclosed by us in reports we file or submit under the Exchange Act is accumulated and communicated to our management, including our CEO and CFO, as appropriate to allow timely decisions regarding disclosure and is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the Securities and Exchange Commission’s rules and forms.

 

Our CEO and CFO have concluded that, based on their review, our disclosure controls and procedures are effective to provide such reasonable assurance.

 

Our management, including the CEO and CFO, believes that any disclosure controls and procedures or internal controls and procedures, no matter how well conceived and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system are met. Further, the design of a control system must consider the benefits of controls relative to their costs. Inherent limitations within a control system include the realities that judgments in decision-making can be faulty, and that breakdowns can occur because of simple error or mistake. Additionally, controls can be circumvented by the individual acts of some persons, by collusion of two or more people, or by unauthorized override of the control. Over time, controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions or deterioration in the degree of compliance with associated policies or procedures. While the design of any system of controls is to provide reasonable assurance of the effectiveness of disclosure controls, such design is also based in part upon certain assumptions about the likelihood of future events, and such assumptions, while reasonable, may not take into account all potential future conditions. Accordingly, because of the inherent limitations in a cost effective control system, misstatements due to error or fraud may occur and may not be prevented or detected.

 

Our management has conducted an assessment of its internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011 as required by Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. Management’s report on our internal control over financial reporting is included below. The Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm’s report with respect to the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting is included on page F-2. Management has concluded that internal control over financial reporting is effective as of December 31, 2011.

 

51



 

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

 

There has been no change in our internal control over financial reporting during the most recent quarter that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

 

Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

 

Management, under the supervision of our CEO and CFO, is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. Internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d(f) under the Exchange Act) is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with U.S. GAAP. Internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures which (a) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of assets, (b) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP, (c) provide reasonable assurance that receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with appropriate authorization of management and the Board of Directors, and (d) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

In connection with the preparation of this Form 10-K, our management, under the supervision and with the participation of our CEO and CFO, conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011 based on the framework established in Internal Control – Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”). As a result of that evaluation, management has concluded that our internal control over financial reporting was effective at a reasonable assurance level as of December 31, 2011. The effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011 has also been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, our independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report, which is included in “Part II – Item 8 – Financial Statements and Supplementary Data.”

 

ITEM 9B.  OTHER INFORMATION

 

None.

 

PART III

 

ITEM 10.  DIRECTORS, EXECUTIVE OFFICERS AND CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

 

The information in our 2012 Definitive Proxy Statement on Schedule 14A (the “2012 Proxy Statement”) regarding our executive officers under the heading “Information Regarding Executive Officers” is incorporated herein by reference. We have a Code of Ethical Conduct for Financial Managers for Senior Financial Officers and a Policy of Business Conduct. The Code of Ethical Conduct for Financial Managers applies to our CEO, CFO, Controller or persons performing similar functions. The Code of Conduct applies to all of our directors, officers and employees and those of our subsidiaries. Both the Code of Ethical Conduct for Financial Managers and the Code of Conduct are posted on our website at www.teletech.com on the Corporate Governance page. We will post on our website any amendments to or waivers of the Code of Ethical Conduct for Financial Managers or Code of Conduct for executive officers or directors, in accordance with applicable laws and regulations. The remaining information called for by this Item 10 is incorporated by reference herein from the discussions under the headings captions “Election of Directors” and “Code of Conduct and Committee Charters” in our 2012 Proxy Statement and is incorporated by reference herein.

 

ITEM 11.  EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION

 

The information in our 2012 Proxy Statement set forth under the captions “Executive Compensation” and “Compensation Committee Report” is incorporated herein by reference.

 

52



 

ITEM 12.  SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT
AND RELATED STOCKHOLDER MATTERS

 

The information in our 2012 Proxy Statement set forth under the captions “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management” and “Equity Compensation Plan Information” is incorporated herein by reference.

 

ITEM 13.  CERTAIN RELATIONSHIPS AND RELATED TRANSACTIONS,
AND DIRECTOR INDEPENDENCE

 

The information in our 2012 Proxy Statement set forth under the caption “Certain Relationships and Related Party Transactions” is incorporated herein by reference.

 

ITEM 14.  PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANTS FEES AND SERVICES

 

The information in our 2012 Proxy Statement set forth under the caption “Fees Paid to Accountants” is incorporated herein by reference.

 

PART IV

 

ITEM 15.  EXHIBITS AND FINANCIAL STATEMENT SCHEDULES

 

(a)         The following documents are filed as part of this report:

 

1.   Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

The Index to Consolidated Financial Statements is set forth on page F-1 of this report.

 

2.   Financial Statement Schedules.

 

All schedules for TeleTech have been omitted since the required information is not present or not present in amounts sufficient to require submission of the schedule, or because the information is included in the respective Consolidated Financial Statements or notes thereto.

 

3.   Exhibits.

 

EXHIBIT INDEX

 

Exhibit No.

 

Description

3.01

 

Restated Certificate of Incorporation of TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to TeleTech’s Amendment No. 2 to Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-04097) filed on July 5, 1996)

 

 

 

3.02

 

Second Amended and Restated Bylaws of TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.02 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on May 28, 2009)

 

 

 

10.01

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Stock Plan, as amended and restated (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to TeleTech’s Amendment No. 2 to Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-04097) filed on July 5, 1996)**

 

 

 

10.02

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Amended and Restated Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to TeleTech’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-113432) filed on March 9, 2004)**

 

 

 

10.03

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Directors Stock Option Plan, as amended and restated (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to TeleTech’s Amendment No. 2 to Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-04097) filed on July 5, 1996)**

 

 

 

10.04

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Amended and Restated 1999 Stock Option and Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to TeleTech’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-96617) filed on July 17, 2002)**

 

53



 

Exhibit No.

 

Description

10.05

 

Amendment to 1999 Stock Option and Incentive Plan dated February 11, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.05 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

 

 

 

10.06

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc. 2010 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to TeleTech’s Definitive Proxy Statement, filed April 12, 2010)**

 

 

 

10.07

 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (effective in 2007 and 2008) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.05 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)**

 

 

 

10.08

 

Amendment to Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (effective December 2008) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.07 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

 

 

 

10.09

 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (effective in 2009) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 17, 2009)**

 

 

 

10.10

 

Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (below Vice President) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.06 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)**

 

 

 

10.11

 

Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (Vice President and above) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.07 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)**

 

 

 

10.12

 

Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (Non-Employee Director) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.08 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)**

 

 

 

10.13

 

Independent Director Compensation Arrangements (effective May 21, 2009) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2009)**

 

 

 

10.14

 

Employment Agreement between James E. Barlett and TeleTech dated October 15, 2001 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.66 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001)**

 

 

 

10.15

 

Amendment to Employment Agreement between James E. Barlett and TeleTech dated December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

 

 

 

10.16

 

Stock Option Agreement dated October 15, 2001 between James E. Barlett and TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.70 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001)**

 

 

 

10.17

 

Amendment dated September 17, 2008 to Stock Option Agreement between James E. Barlett and TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

 

 

 

10.18

 

Employment Agreement between Kenneth D. Tuchman and TeleTech dated October 15, 2001 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.68 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001)**

 

 

 

10.19

 

Amendment to Employment Agreement between Kenneth D. Tuchman and TeleTech dated December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.17 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

 

 

 

10.20

 

Amendment dated September 17, 2008 to Stock Option Agreement between Kenneth D. Tuchman and TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

 

54



 

Exhibit No.

 

Description

10.21

 

Credit Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2010, among TeleTech Holdings, Inc., the lenders party thereto, KeyBank National Association, as Joint Lead Arranger, Sole Book Runner and Administrative Agent, Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, as Joint Lead Arranger and Co-Syndication Agent, Bank of America, N.A., as Co-Syndication Agent, BBVA Compass, as Co-Documentation Agent and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Co-Documentation Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 7, 2010)

 

 

 

10.22

 

Form of Indemnification Agreement with Directors (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 17, 2010)**

 

 

 

10.23

 

Form of Amendment to Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 17, 2010)**

 

 

 

10.24

 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 17, 2010)**

 

 

 

10.25

 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (Section 16 Officers) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to TeleTech’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-167300) filed on June 3, 2010)**

 

 

 

10.26

 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (Non-Section 16 Employees) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to TeleTech’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-167300) filed on June 3, 2010)**

 

 

 

10.27

 

Form of Independent Director Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.5 to TeleTech’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-167300) filed on June 3, 2010)**

 

 

 

10.28

 

Executive Employment Agreement dated March 8, 2010 between Joseph Bellini and TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2010)**

 

 

 

10.29

 

First Amendment to Executive Employment Agreement, dated September 20, 2010 between TeleTech and Joseph Bellini (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2010)**

 

 

 

10.30

 

Second Amendment, dated as of April 19, 2011, to TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Restricted Stock Unit Agreement by and between TeleTech Holdings, Inc. and James E. Barlett dated June 22, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed April 22, 2011)**

 

 

 

10.31

 

Employment Agreement between Regina Paolillo and TeleTech Holdings, Inc. effective as of November 3, 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed October 27, 2011)**

 

 

 

10.32

 

Restricted Stock Unit Agreement dated as of November 15, 2011 between TeleTech Holdings, Inc. and Regina Paolillo (RSU Agreement) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K/A filed November 21, 2011)**

 

 

 

10.33

 

Restricted Stock Unit Agreement dated as of November 15, 2011 between TeleTech Holdings, Inc. and Regina Paolillo (RSU Performance Agreement) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K/A filed November 21, 2011)**

 

 

 

10.34

 

Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement dated as of November 15, 2011 between TeleTech Holdings, Inc. and Regina Paolillo (Option Agreement)(incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K/A filed November 21, 2011)**

 

 

 

10.35

 

General Release Agreement between Carol Kline and TeleTech Holdings, Inc. effective as of January 26, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed January 31, 2012)**

 

 

 

21.01*

 

List of subsidiaries

 

 

 

23.01*

 

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

 

 

31.01*

 

Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of CEO of TeleTech

 

 

 

31.02*

 

Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of CFO of TeleTech

 

 

 

32.01*

 

Written Statement of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (18 U.S.C. Section 1350)

 

 

 

32.02*

 

Written Statement of Acting Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (18 U.S.C. Section 1350)

 

 

 

101.INS***

 

XBRL Instance Document

 

 

 

101.SCH***

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document

 

 

 

101.CAL***

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document.

 

 

 

101.LAB***

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document

 

 

 

101.PRE***

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document

 

 

 

101.DEF***

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document

 

 

 

 

55



____________

 

*

Filed herewith.

 

 

**

Identifies exhibit that consists of or includes a management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.

 

 

***

Attached as Exhibit 101 to this report are the following documents formatted in XBRL (Extensible Business Reporting Language): (i) Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, (ii) Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, (iii) Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, (iv) Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, and (v) Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. Users of this data are advised pursuant to Rule 406T of Regulation S-T that this interactive data file is deemed not filed or part of a registration statement or prospectus for purposes of sections 11 or 12 of the Securities Act of 1933, is deemed not filed for purposes of section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and otherwise is not subject to liability under these sections.

 

56



 

SIGNATURES

 

Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned; thereunto duly authorized on February 28, 2012.

 

 

 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

 

By:

/s/ KENNETH D. TUCHMAN

 

 

 

Chief Executive Officer     

 

 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below on February 28, 2012, by the following persons on behalf of the registrant and in the capacities indicated:

 

Signature

 

Title

 

 

 

/s/ KENNETH D. TUCHMAN

 

PRINCIPAL EXECUTIVE OFFICER

Kenneth D. Tuchman

 

Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of the Board

 

 

 

/s/ REGINA M. PAOLILLO

 

PRINCIPAL FINANCIAL AND ACCOUNTING OFFICER

Regina M. Paolillo

 

Chief Financial Officer

 

 

 

/s/ JAMES E. BARLETT

 

DIRECTOR

James E. Barlett

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ WILLIAM A. LINNENBRINGER

 

DIRECTOR

William A. Linnenbringer

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ RUTH C. LIPPER

 

DIRECTOR

Ruth C. Lipper

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ SHRIKANT MEHTA

 

DIRECTOR

Shrikant Mehta

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ ANJAN MUKHERJEE

 

DIRECTOR

Anjan Mukherjee

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ ROBERT M. TAROLA

 

DIRECTOR

Robert M. Tarola

 

 

 

 

 

/s/ SHIRLEY YOUNG

 

DIRECTOR

Shirley Young

 

 

 

57



 

INDEX TO THE CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC.

 

 

Page No.

 

 

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

F-2

 

 

Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010

F-3

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income for the Years Ended
December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009

F-4

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity for the Years Ended December 31, 2011,
2010 and 2009

F-5

 

 

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the Years Ended December 31, 2011, 2010
and 2009

F-6

 

 

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

F-7

 

F - 1



 

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

To the Stockholders and the Board of Directors of

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc.

 

In our opinion, the accompanying consolidated balance sheets and the related consolidated statements of operations and comprehensive income, of stockholders’ equity and of cash flows present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of TeleTech Holdings, Inc. and its subsidiaries at December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2011 based on criteria established in Internal Control - Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in Management’s Report on Internal Control Over Financial Reporting appearing under Item 9A. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.

 

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

/s/  PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP

 

Denver, CO

February 28, 2012

 

F - 2



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Balance Sheets

(Amounts in thousands except share amounts)

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

2011 

 

 

2010 

ASSETS

 

 

 

 

 

Current assets

 

 

 

 

 

Cash and cash equivalents 

$

 156,371 

 

$

 119,385 

Accounts receivable, net

 

 243,636 

 

 

 233,706 

Prepaids and other current assets

 

 37,434 

 

 

 38,486 

Deferred tax assets, net

 

 22,994 

 

 

 8,770 

Income tax receivable

 

 17,847 

 

 

 23,869 

Total current assets

 

 478,282 

 

 

 424,216 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Long-term assets

 

 

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment, net

 

 100,321 

 

 

 105,528 

Goodwill

 

 70,844 

 

 

 52,707 

Contract acquisition costs, net

 

 2,866 

 

 

 2,782 

Deferred tax assets, net

 

 32,512 

 

 

 37,944 

Other long-term assets

 

 62,153 

 

 

 37,446 

Total long-term assets

 

 268,696 

 

 

 236,407 

Total assets

$

 746,978 

 

$

 660,623 

 

 

 

 

 

 

LIABILITIES AND STOCKHOLDERS’ EQUITY

 

 

 

 

 

Current liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts payable

$

 27,555 

 

$

 23,599 

Accrued employee compensation and benefits

 

 71,500 

 

 

 72,406 

Other accrued expenses

 

 33,816 

 

 

 40,682 

Income tax payable

 

 10,051 

 

 

 23,175 

Deferred tax liabilities, net

 

 912 

 

 

 2,235 

Deferred revenue

 

 15,895 

 

 

 5,570 

Other current liabilities

 

 10,282 

 

 

 4,584 

Total current liabilities

 

 170,011 

 

 

 172,251 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Long-term liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

Line of credit

 

 64,000 

 

 

 - 

Negative investment in deconsolidated subsidiary

 

 76 

 

 

 76 

Deferred tax liabilities, net

 

 3,020 

 

 

 3,559 

Deferred rent

 

 6,729 

 

 

 10,363 

Other long-term liabilities

 

 32,895 

 

 

 19,556 

Total long-term liabilities

 

 106,720 

 

 

 33,554 

Total liabilities

 

 276,731 

 

 

 205,805 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commitments and contingencies  (Note 15)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Stockholders’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

Preferred stock; $0.01 par; 10,000,000 shares authorized; zero shares outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and 2010

 

 - 

 

 

 - 

Common stock; $.01 par value; 150,000,000 shares authorized; 56,635,319 and 57,875,269 shares outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively

 

 566 

 

 

 579 

Additional paid-in capital

 

 350,386 

 

 

 349,157 

Treasury stock at cost: 25,416,934 and 24,179,176 shares, respectively as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively

 

 (357,267)

 

 

 (322,946)

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss)

 

 (5,474)

 

 

 20,334 

Retained earnings

 

 470,776 

 

 

 396,602 

Noncontrolling interest

 

 11,260 

 

 

 11,092 

Total stockholders’ equity

 

 470,247 

 

 

 454,818 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ equity

$

 746,978 

 

$

 660,623 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F - 3



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income

(Amounts in thousands except per share amounts)

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

2011 

 

 

2010 

 

 

2009 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue

$

1,179,388 

 

$

1,094,906 

 

$

1,167,915 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cost of services (exclusive of depreciation and amortization presented separately below)

 

 848,362 

 

 

 789,697 

 

 

 820,517 

Selling, general and administrative

 

 188,802 

 

 

 165,812 

 

 

 180,039 

Depreciation and amortization

 

 44,889 

 

 

 50,218 

 

 

 56,991 

Restructuring charges, net

 

 3,651 

 

 

 13,476 

 

 

 5,072 

Impairment losses

 

 230 

 

 

 1,958 

 

 

 4,587 

Total operating expenses

 

 1,085,934 

 

 

 1,021,161 

 

 

 1,067,206 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income from operations

 

 93,454 

 

 

 73,745 

 

 

 100,709 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other income (expense)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest income

 

 3,064 

 

 

 2,129 

 

 

 2,634 

Interest expense

 

 (5,118)

 

 

 (3,161)

 

 

 (3,158)

Other income (expense), net

 

 154 

 

 

 9,256 

 

 

 2,858 

Total other income (expense)

 

 (1,900)

 

 

 8,224 

 

 

 2,334 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income before income taxes

 

 91,554 

 

 

 81,969 

 

 

 103,043 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for income taxes

 

 (13,279)

 

 

 (28,431)

 

 

 (27,477)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

 

 78,275 

 

 

 53,538 

 

 

 75,566 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income attributable to noncontrolling interest

 

 (4,101)

 

 

 (3,664)

 

 

 (3,812)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income attributable to TeleTech stockholders

$

 74,174 

 

$

 49,874 

 

$

 71,754 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other comprehensive income (loss)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

$

 78,275 

 

$

 53,538 

 

$

 75,566 

Foreign currency translation adjustments

 

 (12,596)

 

 

 8,080 

 

 

 18,231 

Derivative valuation, net of tax

 

 (12,942)

 

 

 2,623 

 

 

 25,647 

Other

 

 (655)

 

 

 (792)

 

 

 - 

Total comprehensive income

 

 52,082 

 

 

 63,449 

 

 

 119,444 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Comprehensive income attributable to noncontrolling interest

 

 (3,716)

 

 

 (3,754)

 

 

 (4,157)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Comprehensive income attributable to TeleTech stockholders

$

 48,366 

 

$

 59,695 

 

$

 115,287 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

 56,669 

 

 

 60,361 

 

 

 62,891 

Diluted

 

 57,963 

 

 

 61,792 

 

 

 64,238 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income per share attributable to TeleTech stockholders

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

$

1.31 

 

$

0.83 

 

$

1.14 

Diluted

$

1.28 

 

$

0.81 

 

$

1.12 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F - 4



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity

(Amounts in thousands)

 

 

Stockholders’ Equity of the Company

 

 

 

Preferred Stock

Common Stock

Treasury Stock

Additional
Paid-in Capital

Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)

Retained
Earnings

Noncontrolling
interest

Total Equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shares

Amount

Shares

Amount

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2008

-

$

-  

63,816 

$

638 

$

(228,596)

$

341,887 

$

(33,020)

$     274,974 

$

5,011 

$

360,894 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

-

-  

-  

71,754 

3,812 

75,566 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dividends distributed to noncontrolling interest

-

-  

-  

-  

(3,690)

(3,690)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign currency translation adjustments

-

-  

17,886 

-  

345 

18,231 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives valuation, net of tax

-

-  

25,647 

-  

-  

25,647 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vesting of restricted stock units

-

307 

3,855 

(5,777)

-  

-  

-  

(1,919)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Exercise of stock options

-

621 

7,791 

(1,638)

-  

-  

-  

6,159 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Excess tax benefit from equity-based awards

-

(1,861)

-  

-  

-  

(1,861)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equity-based compensation expense

-

11,640

-  

-  

-  

11,640 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases of common stock

-

(2,526)

(25)

(34,741)

-  

-  

-  

-  

(34,766)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2009

-

$

-       

62,218   

$

622    

$

(251,691)

$

344,251   

$

10,513   

$    346,728 

$

5,478   

$

455,901 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

-

-  

-  

49,874 

3,664 

53,538 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Noncontrolling interest (Note 2)

-

-  

-  

-  

6,000 

6,000 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dividends distributed to noncontrolling interest

-

-  

-  

-  

(4,140)

(4,140)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign currency translation adjustments

-

-  

7,990 

-  

90 

8,080 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives valuation, net of tax

-

-  

2,623 

-  

-  

2,623 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vesting of restricted stock units

-

420 

5

5,448 

(8,525)

-  

-  

-  

(3,072)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Exercise of stock options

-

273 

3

3,541 

(752)

-  

-  

-  

2,792 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Excess tax benefit from equity-based awards

-

811 

-  

-  

-  

811 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equity-based compensation expense

-

13,372 

-  

-  

-  

13,372 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases of common stock

 

 

(5,036)

(51)

(80,244)

-  

-  

-  

(80,295)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other

-

(792)

-  

-  

(792)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2010

-

-       

57,875   

$

579    

$

(322,946)

$

349,157   

$

20,334   

$  396,602   

$

11,092   

$

454,818 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

-

-  

74,174 

4,101 

78,275 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dividends distributed to noncontrolling interest

-

-  

-  

(3,548)

(3,548)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign currency translation adjustments

-

(12,211)

-  

(385)

(12,596)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives valuation, net of tax

-

(12,942)

-  

-  

(12,942)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vesting of restricted stock units

-

561 

7,706 

(13,104)

-  

-  

-  

(5,393)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Exercise of stock options

-

1,564 

15 

21,633 

(6,886)

-  

-  

-  

14,762 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Excess tax benefit from equity-based awards

-

5,363 

-  

-  

-  

5,363 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Equity-based compensation expense

-

15,856 

-  

-  

-  

15,856 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases of common stock

-

(3,365)

(33)

(63,660)

-  

-  

-  

(63,693)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other

-

(655)

-  

-  

(655)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2011

-

$

-       

56,635 

$

566 

$

(357,267)

$

350,386 

$

(5,474)

$    470,776

$

11,260 

$

470,247 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F - 5



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(Amounts in thousands)

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

2011 

 

2010 

 

2009 

Cash flows from operating activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income

$

 78,275 

 

$

 53,538 

 

$

 75,566 

Adjustment to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

 44,889 

 

 

 50,218 

 

 

 56,991 

Amortization of contract acquisition costs

 

 1,680 

 

 

 5,267 

 

 

 3,450 

Amortization of debt issuance costs and other

 

 589 

 

 

 672 

 

 

 596 

Accretion expense

 

 544 

 

 

 132 

 

 

 90 

Provision for doubtful accounts

 

 363 

 

 

 600 

 

 

 1,412 

Loss (gain) on disposal of assets

 

 (415)

 

 

 (617)

 

 

 1,603 

Impairment losses

 

 230 

 

 

 1,958 

 

 

 4,587 

Deferred income taxes

 

 1,658 

 

 

 (3,030)

 

 

 6,066 

Excess tax benefit from equity-based awards

 

 (6,491)

 

 

 (1,783)

 

 

 (484)

Equity-based compensation expense

 

 15,856 

 

 

 13,372 

 

 

 11,640 

(Gain) loss on foreign currency derivatives

 

 1,073 

 

 

 (128)

 

 

 (192)

Gain on Newgen legal settlement, net of tax

 

 - 

 

 

 (3,542)

 

 

 - 

Changes in assets and liabilities, net of acquisitions:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts receivable

 

 (5,789)

 

 

 (87)

 

 

 27,258 

Prepaids and other assets

 

 3,578 

 

 

 17,664 

 

 

 (8,651)

Accounts payable and accrued expenses

 

 (16,502)

 

 

 19,683 

 

 

 (19,142)

Deferred revenue and other liabilities

 

 (5,739)

 

 

 (19,462)

 

 

 (118)

Net cash provided by operating activities

 

 113,799 

 

 

 134,455 

 

 

 160,672 

Cash flows from investing activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment

 

 2,034 

 

 

 - 

 

 

 - 

Proceeds from grant for property, plant and equipment

 

 357 

 

 

 - 

 

 

 785 

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

 

 (38,667)

 

 

 (26,800)

 

 

 (24,973)

Settlement of foreign currency contracts for net investment hedging

 

 - 

 

 

 - 

 

 

 (1,727)

Payment for contract acquisition costs

 

 (1,758)

 

 

 - 

 

 

 (3,900)

Investment in deconsolidated subsidiary

 

 - 

 

 

 (3,600)

 

 

 - 

Deposit on pending acquisition

 

 (3,026)

 

 

 - 

 

 

 - 

Acquisitions, net of cash acquired of $14 and $2,202, respectively

 

 (45,871)

 

 

 (12,798)

 

 

 - 

Net cash used in investing activities

 

 (86,931)

 

 

 (43,198)

 

 

 (29,815)

Cash flows from financing activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Proceeds from line of credit

 

 678,200 

 

 

 1,257,100 

 

 

 920,960 

Payments on line of credit

 

 (614,200)

 

 

 (1,257,100)

 

 

 (1,001,760)

Payments on capital lease obligations and equipment financing

 

 (2,099)

 

 

 (3,749)

 

 

 (2,332)

Dividends distributed to noncontrolling interest

 

 (3,548)

 

 

 (4,140)

 

 

 (3,690)

Proceeds from exercise of stock options

 

 14,762 

 

 

 2,792 

 

 

 6,159 

Excess tax benefit from equity based awards

 

 6,491 

 

 

 1,783 

 

 

 484 

Purchase of treasury stock

 

 (63,693)

 

 

 (80,295)

 

 

 (34,766)

Payments of debt issuance costs

 

 (22)

 

 

 (2,288)

 

 

 - 

Net cash provided by (used in) financing activities

 

 15,891 

 

 

 (85,897)

 

 

 (114,945)

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

 

 (5,773)

 

 

 4,601 

 

 

 5,570 

Increase in cash and cash equivalents

 

 36,986 

 

 

 9,961 

 

 

 21,482 

Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of period

 

 119,385 

 

 

 109,424 

 

 

 87,942 

Cash and cash equivalents, end of period

$

 156,371 

 

$

 119,385 

 

$

 109,424 

Supplemental disclosures

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash paid for interest

$

 4,013 

 

$

 2,217 

 

$

 2,775 

Cash paid for income taxes

$

 24,336 

 

$

 15,593 

 

$

 24,543 

Non-cash investing and financing activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Acquisition of equipment through installment purchase agreements

$

 - 

 

$

 186 

 

$

 3,971 

Landlord incentives credited to deferred rent

$

 - 

 

$

 810 

 

$

 165 

Grant income credited to property, plant and equipment

$

 110 

 

$

 - 

 

$

 745 

Recognition of asset retirement obligations

$

 278 

 

$

 406 

 

$

 183 

 

The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F - 6



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

(1)        OVERVIEW AND SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

Overview

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc. and its subsidiaries (“TeleTech” or the “Company”) serve their clients through the primary businesses of Business Process Outsourcing (“BPO”), which provides outsourced business process, customer management, hosted technology, premise based technology, consulting and marketing services for a variety of industries via operations in the U.S., Argentina, Australia, Belgium, Brazil, Canada, China, Costa Rica, England, France, Germany, Ghana, Italy, Kuwait, Lebanon, Mexico, New Zealand, Northern Ireland, the Philippines, Scotland, South Africa, Spain, Turkey, and the United Arab Emirates.

 

Basis of Presentation

 

The Consolidated Financial Statements are comprised of the accounts of TeleTech, its wholly owned subsidiaries, its 55% equity owned subsidiary Percepta, LLC, and its 80% interest in Peppers & Rogers Group (“PRG”) which was acquired on November 30, 2010 (see Note 2 for additional information). All intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated in consolidation. Operating results for the year ended December 31, 2010 included a $2.0 million reduction to revenue for disputed service delivery issues that occurred in 2009.

 

Certain amounts for 2010 and 2009 have been reclassified in the Consolidated Financial Statements to conform to the 2011 presentation.

 

Use of Estimates

 

The preparation of the Consolidated Financial Statements in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S. (“GAAP”) requires management to make estimates and assumptions in determining the reported amounts of assets and liabilities, disclosure of contingent liabilities at the date of the Consolidated Financial Statements and the reported amounts of revenue and expenses during the reporting period. On an on-going basis, the Company evaluates its estimates including those related to derivatives and hedging activities, income taxes including the valuation allowance for deferred tax assets, self-insurance reserves, litigation reserves, restructuring reserves, allowance for doubtful accounts, and valuation of goodwill, long-lived and intangible assets. The Company bases its estimates on historical experience and on various other assumptions that are believed to be reasonable, the results of which form the basis for making judgments about the carrying values of assets and liabilities. Actual results may differ materially from these estimates under different assumptions or conditions.

 

Concentration of Credit Risk

 

The Company is exposed to credit risk in the normal course of business, primarily related to accounts receivable and derivative instruments. Historically, the losses related to credit risk have been immaterial. The Company regularly monitors its credit risk to mitigate the possibility of current and future exposures resulting in a loss. The Company evaluates the creditworthiness of its clients prior to entering into an agreement to provide services and as necessary through the life of the client relationship. The Company does not believe it is exposed to more than a nominal amount of credit risk in its derivative hedging activities, as the Company diversifies its activities across six well-capitalized, investment-grade financial institutions.

 

Fair Value of Financial Instruments

 

Fair values of cash equivalents and accounts receivable and payable approximate the carrying amounts because of their short-term nature.

 

F - 7



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Cash and Cash Equivalents

 

The Company considers all cash and highly liquid short-term investments with an original maturity of 90 days or less to be cash equivalents. The Company manages a global treasury function in the United States with a particular focus on centralizing and safeguarding its global cash and cash equivalent reserves. While the Company generally prefers to hold U.S. Dollars, it maintains adequate cash in the functional currency of its foreign subsidiaries to support local operating costs. The Company believes that it has effectively mitigated and managed its risk relating to its global cash through its cash management practices, banking partners, and high quality investments. However, the Company can provide no assurances that it will not sustain losses.

 

Accounts Receivable

 

An allowance for doubtful accounts is determined based on the aging of the Company’s accounts receivable, historical experience, client financial condition, and management judgment. The Company writes off accounts receivable against the allowance when the Company determines a balance is uncollectible.

 

Derivatives

 

The Company enters into foreign exchange forward and option contracts to reduce its exposure to currency exchange rate fluctuations that are associated with forecasted revenue earned in foreign locations. The Company also enters into interest rate derivatives which consist of interest rate swaps to reduce the Company’s exposure to interest rate fluctuations associated with its variable rate debt. Upon proper qualification, these contracts are designated as cash flow hedges under current accounting standards. The Company also entered into foreign exchange forward contracts to hedge its net investment in a foreign operation. The Company formally documents at the inception of the hedge all relationships between hedging instruments and hedged items as well as its risk management objective and strategy for undertaking various hedging activities.

 

All derivative financial instruments are reported at fair value and recorded in Other assets and Other liabilities in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets at fair value. Changes in fair value of derivative instruments designated as cash flow hedges are recorded in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), a component of Stockholders’ Equity, to the extent they are deemed effective. Ineffectiveness is measured based on the change in fair value of the forward contracts and the fair value of the hypothetical derivatives with terms that match the critical terms of the risk being hedged. Based on the criteria established by current accounting standards, the Company’s cash flow hedge contracts are deemed to be highly effective. Changes in fair value of the Company’s net investment hedge are recorded in cumulative translation adjustment in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets offsetting the change in cumulative translation adjustment attributable to the hedged portion of the Company’s net investment in the foreign operation. Any realized gains or losses resulting from the foreign currency cash flow hedges are recognized together with the hedged transaction within Revenue.  Any realized gains or losses from the interest rate swaps are recognized in interest income(expense). Gains and losses from the settlements of the Company’s net investment hedges remain in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) until partial or complete liquidation of the applicable net investment.

 

The Company also enters into fair value derivative contracts that hedge against foreign currency exchange gains and losses primarily associated with short-term payables and receivables. Changes in the fair value of derivative instruments designated as fair value hedges affect the carrying value of the asset or liability hedged, with changes in both the derivative instrument and the hedged asset or liability being recognized in Other income (expense), net in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income.

 

In addition to hedging activities, the Company has embedded derivatives in certain foreign lease contracts. The Company bifurcates and calculates the fair values of the embedded derivative feature from the host contract with any changes in fair value of the embedded derivatives recognized in Cost of services.

 

F - 8



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Property, Plant and Equipment

 

Property, plant and equipment are stated at historical cost less accumulated depreciation and amortization. Maintenance, repairs and minor renewals are expensed as incurred.

 

Depreciation and amortization are computed on the straight-line method based on the following estimated useful lives:

 

Building

 

25 years

 

Computer equipment and software

 

3 to 5 years

 

Telephone equipment

 

4 to 7 years

 

Furniture and fixtures

 

5 years

 

Leasehold improvements

 

Lesser of economic useful life (typically 10 years)

 

 

 

or original lease term

 

Other

 

3 to 7 years

 

 

The Company evaluates the carrying value of property, plant and equipment for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amounts may not be recoverable. An asset is considered to be impaired when the forecasted undiscounted cash flows of an asset group are estimated to be less than its carrying value. The amount of impairment recognized is the difference between the carrying value of the asset group and its fair value. Fair value estimates are based on assumptions concerning the amount and timing of forecasted future cash flows.

 

Software Development Costs

 

The Company capitalizes costs incurred to acquire or develop software for internal use. Capitalized software development costs are amortized using the straight-line method over an estimated useful life equal to the lesser of the license term or 4 years.

 

Goodwill

 

The Company evaluates goodwill for possible impairment at least annually in the fourth quarter, and whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of such assets may not be recoverable. The Company uses a three step process to assess the realizability of goodwill based on recently adopted accounting guidance. The first step, Step 0, is a qualitative assessment that analyzes current economic indicators associated with a particular reporting unit. For example, the Company analyzes changes in economic, market and industry conditions, business strategy, cost factors, and financial performance, among others, to determine if there would be a significant decline to the fair value of a particular reporting unit. A qualitative assessment also includes analyzing the excess fair value of a reporting unit over its carrying value from impairment assessments performed in previous years. If the qualitative assessment indicates a stable or improved fair value, no further testing is required.

 

If a qualitative assessment indicates that a significant decline to fair value of a reporting unit is more likely than not, or if a reporting unit’s fair value has historically been closer to its carrying value, the Company will proceed to Step 1 testing where the Company calculates the fair value of a reporting unit based on discounted future probability-weighted cash flows. If Step 1 indicates that the carrying value of a reporting unit is in excess of its fair value, the Company will proceed to Step 2 where the fair value of the reporting unit will be allocated to assets and liabilities as they would in a business combination. Impairment occurs when the carrying amount of goodwill exceeds its estimated fair value calculated in Step 2.

 

Contract Acquisition Costs

 

Amounts paid to or on behalf of clients to obtain long-term contracts are capitalized and amortized in proportion to the initial expected future revenue from the contract, which in most cases results in straight-line amortization over the life of the contract. These costs are recorded as a reduction to Revenue. The Company evaluates the recoverability of these costs based on the individual underlying client contracts’ forecasted future cash flows.

 

F - 9



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Other Intangible Assets

 

The Company has other intangible assets that include customer relationships (definite-lived) and trade names (indefinite-lived). Definite-lived intangible assets are amortized on a straight-line basis over their estimated useful lives, which range from less than one year to 11 years. The Company evaluates the carrying value of its definite-lived intangible assets whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount may not be recoverable. An asset is considered to be impaired when the forecasted undiscounted cash flows of an asset group are estimated to be less than its carrying value. The Company evaluates indefinite-lived intangible assets for possible impairment at least annually or whenever events or changes in circumstances indicate that the carrying amount of such assets may not be recoverable. An intangible asset with an indefinite life (a trade name) is evaluated for possible impairment by comparing the fair value of the asset with its carrying value. Fair value is estimated as the discounted value of future revenues arising from a trade name using a royalty rate that an independent party would pay for use of that trade name. An impairment charge is recorded if the trade name’s carrying value exceeds its estimated fair value.

 

Self Insurance Liabilities

 

The Company self-insures for certain levels of workers’ compensation, employee health and general liability insurance. The Company records estimated liabilities for these insurance lines based upon analyses of historical claims experience. The most significant assumption the Company makes in estimating these liabilities is that future claims experience will emerge in a similar pattern with historical claims experience. The liabilities related to workers’ compensation and employee health insurance are included in Accrued employee compensation and benefits in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets. The liability for other general liability insurance is included in Other accrued expenses in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets.

 

Restructuring Liabilities

 

The Company routinely assesses the profitability and utilization of its delivery centers and existing markets. In some cases, the Company has chosen to close under-performing delivery centers and complete reductions in workforce to enhance future profitability. Severance payments that occur from reductions in workforce are in accordance with the Company’s postemployment plans and/or statutory requirements that are communicated to all employees upon hire date; therefore, severance liabilities are recognized when they are determined to be probable and reasonably estimable. Other liabilities for costs associated with an exit or disposal activity are recognized when the liability is incurred, rather than upon commitment to a plan.

 

A significant assumption used in determining the amount of estimated liability for closing delivery centers is the future lease payments on vacant centers, which the Company determines based on its ability to successfully negotiate early termination agreements with landlords and/or to sublease the facility. If the Company’s actual results differ from these estimates, additional gains or losses would be recorded within Restructuring charges, net in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income. The accrual for restructuring liabilities is included in Other accrued expenses in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets.

 

Grant Advances

 

The Company receives grants from various government levels as an incentive to locate delivery centers in their jurisdictions. The Company’s policy is to account for grant monies received in advance as a liability and recognize to income as either a reduction to Cost of services or Depreciation expense over the term of the grant, when it is reasonably assured that the conditions of the grant have been or will be met.

 

F - 10



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Income Taxes

 

Accounting for income taxes required recognition of deferred tax assets and liabilities for the expected future income tax consequences of transactions that have been included in the Consolidated Financial Statements or tax returns. Under this method, deferred tax assets and liabilities are determined based on the difference between the financial statement and tax basis of assets and liabilities using enacted tax rates in effect for the year in which the differences are expected to reverse. Gross deferred tax assets may then be reduced by a valuation allowance for amounts that do not satisfy the realization criteria established by current accounting standards.

 

The Company accounts for uncertain tax positions using a two-step approach to recognizing and measuring uncertain tax positions. The first step is to determine if the weight of available evidence indicates that it is more likely than not that the tax position will be sustained on audit. The second step is to estimate and measure the tax benefit as the amount that has a greater than 50% likelihood of being realized upon ultimate settlement with the tax authority. The Company evaluates these uncertain tax positions on a quarterly basis. This evaluation is based on the consideration of several factors including changes in facts or circumstances, changes in applicable tax law, and settlement of issues under audit. The Company recognizes interest and penalties related to uncertain tax positions as a part of the Provision for income taxes in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income.

 

The Company provides for U.S. income tax expense on the earnings of foreign subsidiaries unless the subsidiaries’ earnings are considered permanently reinvested outside the U.S.

 

Equity-Based Compensation Expense

 

Equity-based compensation expense for all share-based payment awards granted is determined based on the grant-date fair value net of an estimated forfeiture rate on a straight-line basis over the requisite service period of the award, which is typically the vesting term of the share-based payment award. The Company estimates the forfeiture rate annually based on its historical experience of forfeited awards.

 

Foreign Currency Translation

 

The assets and liabilities of the Company’s foreign subsidiaries, whose functional currency is not the U.S. dollar, are translated at the exchange rates in effect on the last day of the period and income and expenses are translated using the monthly average exchange rates in effect for the period in which the items occur. Foreign currency translation gains and losses are recorded in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) within equity. Foreign currency transaction gains and losses are included in Other income (expense), net in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income.

 

Revenue Recognition

 

The Company recognizes revenue when evidence of an arrangement exists, the delivery of service has occurred, the fee is fixed or determinable and collection is reasonably assured. The BPO inbound and outbound service fees are based on either a per minute, per hour, per transaction or per call basis. Certain client programs provide for adjustments to monthly billings based upon whether the Company achieves, exceeds or fails certain performance criteria. Adjustments to monthly billings consist of contractual bonuses/penalties, holdbacks and other performance based contingencies. Revenue recognition is limited to the amount that is not contingent upon delivery of future services or meeting other specified performance conditions.

 

F - 11



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Revenue also consists of services for agent training, program launch, professional consulting, fully-hosted or managed technology and learning innovation services. These service offerings may contain multiple element arrangements whereby the Company determines if those service offerings represent separate units of accounting. A deliverable constitutes a separate unit of accounting when it has standalone value, and where return rights exist, delivery or performance of the undelivered items is considered probable and substantially within our control. If those deliverables are determined to be separate units of accounting, revenue is recognized as services are provided. If those deliverables are not determined to be separate units of accounting, revenue for the delivered services are bundled into one unit of accounting and recognized over the life of the arrangement or at the time all services and deliverables have been delivered and satisfied. The Company allocates revenue to each of the deliverables based on a selling price hierarchy of vendor specific objective evidence (“VSOE”), third-party evidence, and then estimated selling price. VSOE is based on the price charged when the deliverable is sold separately. Third-party evidence is based on largely interchangeable competitor services in standalone sales to similarly situated customers. Estimated selling price is based on the Company’s best estimate of what the selling prices of deliverables would be if they were sold regularly on a standalone basis. Estimated selling price is established considering multiple factors including, but not limited to, pricing practices in different geographies, service offerings, and customer classifications. Once the Company allocates revenue to each deliverable, the Company recognizes revenue when all revenue recognition criteria are met.

 

Periodically, the Company will make certain expenditures related to acquiring contracts or provide up-front discounts for future services. These expenditures are capitalized as Contract Acquisition Costs and amortized in proportion to the expected future revenue from the contract, which in most cases results in straight-line amortization over the life of the contract. Amortization of these costs is recorded as a reduction to revenue.

 

Deferred Revenue and Costs

 

The Company records amounts billed and received, but not earned, as deferred revenue. These amounts are recorded in Deferred revenue or as a component of Other long-term liabilities in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets based on the period over which the Company expects to render services.

 

Current accounting standards require the deferral of revenue for initial training that occurs upon commencement of a new client contract if that training is billed separately to a client. Accordingly, the corresponding training costs, consisting primarily of labor and related expenses, are also deferred. In these circumstances, both the training revenue and costs are amortized straight-line over the life of the client contract as a component of Revenue and Cost of services, respectively. In situations where these initial training costs are not billed separately, but rather included in the hourly service rates paid by the client over the life of the contract, no deferral is necessary as the revenue is being recognized over the life of the contract and the associated training costs are expensed as incurred.

 

Rent Expense

 

The Company has negotiated certain rent holidays, landlord/tenant incentives and escalations in the base price of rent payments over the initial term of its operating leases. The initial term includes the “build-out” period of leases, where no rent payments are typically due. The Company recognizes rent holidays and rent escalations on a straight-line basis to rent expense over the lease term. The landlord/tenant incentives are recorded as an increase to deferred rent liabilities and amortized on a straight line basis to rent expense over the initial lease term.

 

Asset Retirement Obligations

 

Asset retirement obligations relate to legal obligations associated with the retirement of long-lived assets resulting from the acquisition, construction, development and/or normal use of the underlying assets.

 

F - 12



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The Company records all asset retirement obligations at estimated fair value. The Company’s asset retirement obligations primarily relate to clauses in its delivery center operating leases which require the Company to return the leased premises to its original condition. The associated asset retirement obligations are capitalized as part of the carrying amount of the underlying asset and depreciated over the estimated useful life of the asset. The liability, reported within Other long-term liabilities, is accreted through charges to operating expenses. If the asset retirement obligation is settled for an amount other than the carrying amount of the liability, the Company recognizes a gain or loss on settlement.

 

Recently Issued Accounting Pronouncements

 

Effective January 1, 2011, the Company adopted new revenue guidance that requires an entity to apply the relative selling price allocation method in order to estimate a selling price for all units of accounting, including delivered items when vendor-specific objective evidence or acceptable third-party evidence does not exist. The adoption of this standard did not have a material impact on the Company’s results of operations, financial position, or cash flows.

 

In December 2010, the FASB issued new guidance related to goodwill impairment testing. The new guidance clarifies the requirements of when to perform step 2 of impairment testing for goodwill for reporting units with zero or negative carrying amounts. The Company adopted this guidance on January 1, 2011 and it did not have a material impact on the Company’s results of operations, financial position, or cash flows because the Company has not historically had or is expected to have a reporting unit with goodwill and a zero or negative carrying amount.

 

In May 2011, the FASB amended its guidance, to converge fair value measurement and disclosure guidance in U.S. GAAP with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”). IFRS is a comprehensive series of accounting standards published by the International Accounting Standards Board. The amendment changes the wording used to describe the requirements in U.S. GAAP for measuring fair value and for disclosing information about fair value measurements. The FASB does not intend for the amendment to result in a change in the application of the requirements in the current authoritative guidance. The amendment becomes effective prospectively for the Company’s interim period ending March 31, 2012. Early application is not permitted. The Company does not expect the amendment to have a material impact on its financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

 

In June 2011, the FASB amended its guidance on the presentation of comprehensive income. Under the amended guidance, an entity has the option to present comprehensive income in either one or two consecutive financial statements. A single statement must present the components of net income and total net income, the components of other comprehensive income and total other comprehensive income, and a total for comprehensive income. In a two-statement approach, an entity must present the components of net income and total net income in the first statement. That statement must be immediately followed by a financial statement that presents the components of other comprehensive income, a total for other comprehensive income, and a total for comprehensive income. The option under current guidance that permits the presentation of other comprehensive income in the statement of changes in stockholders’ equity has been eliminated. The amendment becomes effective retrospectively for the Company’s interim period ending March 31, 2012.

 

In September 2011, the FASB amended its guidance on the annual testing of goodwill for impairment. The amended guidance will allow companies to assess qualitative factors to determine if it is more-likely-than-not that goodwill might be impaired and whether it is necessary to perform the two-step goodwill impairment test required under the current accounting standards. This guidance will be effective for annual and interim goodwill impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011. Early adoption of this amended guidance is permitted. The Company early adopted this amended guidance and applied a more qualitative assessment for its annual goodwill impairment test performed on December 1, 2011. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact on its financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

 

F - 13



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

In December 2011, the FASB issued additional guidance related to the presentation of other comprehensive income. This guidance is intended to allow the FASB time to re-deliberate whether it is necessary to require entities to present the effects of reclassifications out of accumulated other comprehensive income in both the statement in which net income is presented and the statement in which other comprehensive income is presented. This guidance defers the effective date of only those provisions in the other comprehensive income guidance that relate to the presentation of reclassification adjustments out of other comprehensive income and reinstates the previous requirements to present reclassification adjustments either on the face of the statement in which other comprehensive income is reported or to disclose them in a note to the financial statements. The amendments in this new guidance are effective at the same time as the amendments in the other comprehensive income guidance explained above, which is for fiscal years, and interim periods within those years, beginning after December 15, 2011. The Company does not expect the adoption of this standard to have a material impact on its financial position, results of operations or cash flows.

 

(2)                                 ACQUISITIONS

 

eLoyalty

 

On May 28, 2011, the Company acquired certain assets and assumed certain liabilities of eLoyalty Corporation (“eLoyalty”), related to the Integrated Contract Solutions (“ICS”) business unit, and the eLoyalty trade name. The ICS business unit focuses on helping clients improve customer service business performance through the implementation of a variety of service centers. ICS generates revenue in three ways: (i) managed services that support and maintain clients’ customer service center environment over the long-term; (ii) consulting services that assist the customer in implementation and integration of a customer service center solution; and (iii) product resale through the sale of third party software and hardware. eLoyalty operates out of an office in Austin, TX with an additional administrative location in Chicago, IL and has approximately 160 employees.

 

The up-front cash consideration was $40.9 million, subject to certain balance sheet adjustments of ($2.9) million as defined in the purchase and sale agreement, for a total purchase price of $38.0 million.

 

As of December 31, 2011, TeleTech had paid the total net purchase price of $38.0 million. The Company paid $0.3 million of acquisition related expenses as part of the eLoyalty purchase. These costs were recorded in Selling, general and administrative expense in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income during the year ended December 31, 2011.

 

F - 14



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The following summarizes the preliminary estimated fair values of the identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed as of the acquisition date (in thousands). The estimates of fair value of identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed, are preliminary, pending completion of the valuation, thus are subject to revisions which may result in adjustments to the values presented below:

 

 

 

Preliminary
Estimates of
Acquisition Date
Fair Value

 

Cash

 

$

  14

 

Accounts receivable

 

7,702

 

Prepaid assets - cost deferrals

 

14,726

 

Property, plant and equipment

 

897

 

Other assets

 

869

 

Deferred tax asset

 

3,735

 

Customer relationships

 

11,700

 

Software

 

1,200

 

Noncompete agreements

 

900

 

Trade name

 

3,300

 

Consulting services backlog

 

500

 

Goodwill

 

18,516

 

 

 

64,059

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts payable

 

2,156

 

Accrued expenses

 

1,211

 

Deferred revenue

 

22,525

 

Other

 

192

 

 

 

26,084

 

 

 

 

 

Total purchase price

 

$

  37,975

 

 

The customer relationship intangible asset is being amortized over 11 years. The goodwill recognized from the eLoyalty acquisition is attributable primarily to the assembled workforce of eLoyalty and significant opportunity for Company growth and marketing based on additional service offerings and capabilities. Since this acquisition is treated as an asset acquisition for tax purposes, the goodwill and associated intangible assets will be deductible for income tax purposes. The operating results of eLoyalty are reported within the North American BPO segment from the date of acquisition.

 

Peppers & Rogers Group

 

On November 30, 2010, the Company acquired an 80% interest in Peppers & Rogers Group. PRG is a leading global management consulting firm specializing in customer-centric strategies for Global 1000 companies and is recognized as a leading authority on customer-based strategies with a deep understanding of the most powerful levers that drive customer loyalty and business results. PRG currently operates offices on six continents across the globe, including headquarters in Stamford, Connecticut, and Istanbul, Turkey, along with regional offices in Belgium, Germany, United Arab Emirates, South Africa, Lebanon and Kuwait. PRG has approximately 150 employees.

 

F - 15



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The up-front cash consideration paid was $15.0 million plus a working capital adjustment of $7.1 million as defined in the purchase and sale agreement. The Company paid an estimated working capital adjustment of $7.9 million during the second quarter of 2011. Upon finalizing the opening balance sheet, the actual working capital adjustment was $7.1 million; therefore, the Company recorded a $0.8 million receivable included in Prepaids and other current assets in the Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011. An additional $5.0 million payment is due on March 1, 2012. This $5.0 million payment was recognized at fair value using a discounted cash flow approach with a discount rate of 18.4%. This measurement is based on significant inputs not observable in the market, which are deemed to be Level 3 inputs. The fair value on the date of acquisition was approximately $4.4 million and was included in Other long-term liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2010. The fair value as of December 31, 2011 was $5.0 million and was included in Other current liabilities in the Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011. This value was accreted up to the $5.0 million payment using the effective interest rate method.

 

The purchase and sale agreement includes a contingent consideration arrangement that requires additional consideration to be paid in 2013 if PRG achieves a specified fiscal year 2012 earnings before interest, taxes depreciation and amortization (“EBITDA”) target. The range of the undiscounted amounts the Company could pay under the contingent consideration agreement is between zero and $5.0 million. The fair value of the contingent consideration recognized on the acquisition date was zero and was estimated by applying the income approach. This measure is based on significant inputs not observable in the market (Level 3 inputs). Key assumptions include (i) a discount rate of 30.6% percent and (ii) probability adjusted level of EBITDA between $9.0 million and $12.6 million. As of December 31, 2011, the fair value of the contingent consideration remains zero since it is currently not likely that PRG will reach its EBITDA target.

 

The fair value of the 20% noncontrolling interest of $6.0 million in PRG was estimated by applying a market approach. This fair value measurement is based on significant inputs not observable in the market (Level 3 inputs). The fair value estimates are based on assumed financial multiples of companies deemed similar to PRG, and assumed adjustments because of the lack of control or lack of marketability that market participants would consider when estimating fair value of the noncontrolling interest in PRG.

 

The purchase and sale agreement also included an option for the Company to acquire the remaining 20% interest in PRG exercisable in 2015 for a period of one year, with a one year extension (the “Initial Exercise Period”). If the Company does not acquire the remaining 20% of PRG pursuant to its call option during the Initial Exercise Period, PRG has an option to purchase the Company’s 80% interest in PRG. The exercise price is based on a multiple of EBITDA as defined in the purchase and sale agreement.

 

F - 16



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The following summarizes the fair values of the identifiable assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date (in thousands).

 

 

 

Acquisition Date
Fair Value

 

Cash

 

$

2,202

 

Accounts receivable

 

16,175

 

Property, plant and equipment

 

322

 

Other assets

 

847

 

Customer relationships

 

9,300

 

Trade name

 

6,400

 

Goodwill

 

7,295

 

 

 

42,541

 

 

 

 

 

Accounts payable

 

1,519

 

Accrued expenses

 

2,010

 

Deferred tax liability

 

3,690

 

Deferred revenue

 

660

 

Line of credit

 

570

 

Other

 

1,562

 

 

 

10,011

 

 

 

 

 

Noncontrolling interest

 

6,000

 

 

 

 

 

Total purchase price

 

$

26,530

 

 

The goodwill recognized from the PRG acquisition is attributable primarily to the assembled workforce of PRG, expected synergies, and other factors. None of the goodwill is deductible for income tax purposes. The operating results of PRG are reported within the International BPO segment from the date of acquisition.

 

The acquired businesses contributed revenues of $80.0 million and $2.3 million and income (loss) from operations of $5.8 million and ($0.4) million to the Company for the years ended December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, respectively.

 

OnState

 

Subsequent to December 31, 2011, the Company entered into an asset purchase agreement with OnState Communications Corporation (“OnState”) to acquire 100% of its assets and assume certain of its liabilities for total cash consideration of $3.3 million. OnState provides hosted business process outsourcing solutions to a variety of small businesses. As of December 31, 2011, the Company had paid a deposit of $3.0 million towards the purchase price of OnState. The cash payment was classified as a non-current asset since the cash paid will be applied towards a business combination primarily made up of non-current intangible assets. The cash payment is included in Other long-term assets in the Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011. The Company released the deposit from escrow and obtained control of OnState on January 1, 2012.

 

iKnowtion

 

As of February 27, 2012, the Company entered into an agreement to acquire an 80% interest in iKnowtion, LLC (“iKnowtion”) with the ability to acquire the remaining 20% after 2015 at pre-determined EBITDA multiples. iKnowtion integrates proven marketing analytics methodologies and business consulting capabilities to help clients improve performance in three critical areas: demand generation, increased wallet share, and channel optimization. The Company paid $1.0 million at closing with deferred payments of up to $4.8 million to acquire 80% of iKnowtion.

 

F - 17



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

(3)                                 SEGMENT INFORMATION

 

The Company’s BPO business provides outsourced business process, consulting, technology services and customer management services for a variety of industries through global delivery centers and represents 100% of total annual revenue. The Company’s North American BPO segment is comprised of sales to all clients based in North America (encompassing the U.S. and Canada), while the Company’s International BPO segment is comprised of sales to clients based in countries outside of North America.

 

The Company allocates to each segment its portion of corporate operating expenses. All inter– company transactions between the reported segments for the periods presented have been eliminated.

 

The following tables present certain financial data by segment (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

As of and for the

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

832,414

 

 

$

824,265

 

 

$

886,738

 

International BPO

 

 

346,974

 

 

 

270,641

 

 

 

281,177

 

Total

 

$

1,179,388

 

 

$

1,094,906

 

 

$

1,167,915

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

33,347

 

 

$

38,652

 

 

$

39,603

 

International BPO

 

 

11,542

 

 

 

11,566

 

 

 

17,388

 

Total

 

$

44,889

 

 

$

50,218

 

 

$

56,991

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income (loss) from operations

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

82,695

 

 

$

83,762

 

 

$

111,497

 

International BPO

 

 

10,759

 

 

 

(10,017

)

 

 

(10,788

)

Total

 

$

93,454

 

 

$

73,745

 

 

$

100,709

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Capital expenditures

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

25,564

 

 

$

19,899

 

 

$

22,892

 

International BPO

 

 

13,103

 

 

 

6,901

 

 

 

2,081

 

Total

 

$

38,667

 

 

$

26,800

 

 

$

24,973

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

482,828

 

 

$

417,632

 

 

$

450,434

 

International BPO

 

 

264,150

 

 

 

242,991

 

 

 

189,733

 

Total

 

$

746,978

 

 

$

660,623

 

 

$

640,167

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goodwill

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

54,401

 

 

$

35,885

 

 

$

35,885

 

International BPO

 

 

16,443

 

 

 

16,822

 

 

 

9,365

 

Total

 

$

70,844

 

 

$

52,707

 

 

$

45,250

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

F - 18



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The following tables present certain financial data based upon the geographic location where the services are provided (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

As of and for the

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

United States

 

$

405,424

 

 

$

406,652

 

 

$

411,438

 

Philippines

 

336,710

 

 

292,726

 

 

309,793

 

Latin America

 

206,986

 

 

203,420

 

 

200,486

 

Europe / Middle East / Africa

 

161,782

 

 

120,643

 

 

138,290

 

Canada

 

51,186

 

 

52,396

 

 

82,500

 

Asia Pacific

 

17,300

 

 

19,069

 

 

25,408

 

Total

 

$

1,179,388

 

 

$

1,094,906

 

 

$

1,167,915

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Property, plant and equipment, gross

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

United States

 

$

280,469

 

 

$

274,335

 

 

$

260,243

 

Philippines

 

100,048

 

 

88,513

 

 

79,898

 

Latin America

 

81,070

 

 

88,984

 

 

85,662

 

Europe / Middle East / Africa

 

20,186

 

 

25,261

 

 

24,517

 

Canada

 

25,788

 

 

29,697

 

 

43,408

 

Asia Pacific

 

27,630

 

 

27,100

 

 

24,610

 

Total

 

$

535,191

 

 

$

533,890

 

 

$

518,338

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other long-term assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

United States

 

$

41,889

 

 

$

14,417

 

 

$

15,127

 

Philippines

 

3,852

 

 

2,906

 

 

2,042

 

Latin America

 

1,048

 

 

1,143

 

 

1,107

 

Europe / Middle East / Africa

 

13,686

 

 

17,241

 

 

1,384

 

Canada

 

212

 

 

113

 

 

164

 

Asia Pacific

 

1,466

 

 

1,626

 

 

1,147

 

Total

 

$

62,153

 

 

$

37,446

 

 

$

20,971

 

 

(4)                                 ACCOUNTS RECEIVABLE AND SIGNIFICANT CLIENTS

 

Accounts receivable, net in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets consists of the following (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

 

Accounts receivable

 

$

247,195

 

 

$

 240,012

 

 

Less:  Allowance for doubtful accounts

 

 (3,559

)

 

 (6,306

)

 

Accounts receivable, net

 

$

 243,636

 

 

$

 233,706

 

 

 

F - 19



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Activity in the Company’s Allowance for doubtful accounts consists of the following (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

 

2009

 

 

Balance, beginning of year

 

$

6,306

 

 

$

5,580

 

 

$

5,551

 

 

Provision for doubtful accounts

 

363

 

 

600

 

 

1,412

 

 

Uncollectible receivables written-off

 

(2,868

)

 

(67

)

 

(2,069

)

 

Effect of foreign currency

 

(242

)

 

193

 

 

686

 

 

Balance, end of year

 

$

3,559

 

 

$

6,306

 

 

$

5,580

 

 

 

Significant Clients

 

The Company had no clients in the years ended December 31, 2011 or 2010 that contributed at least 10% of total revenue and had one client in the year ended 2009 that contributed at least 10% of total revenue as reflected in the table below. This client operates in the communications industry and is included in the North American BPO segment. The revenue from this client as a percentage of total revenue was as follows:

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

T-Mobile

 

6%

 

8%

 

10%

 

 

Accounts receivable from this client was as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

T-Mobile

 

$

17,207

 

$

22,610

 

$

27,569

 

 

The loss of one or more of its significant clients could have a material adverse effect on the Company’s business, operating results, or financial condition. The Company does not require collateral from its clients. To limit the Company’s credit risk, management performs periodic credit evaluations of its clients and maintains allowances for uncollectible accounts and may require pre-payment for services. Although the Company is impacted by economic conditions in various industry segments, management does not believe significant credit risk exists as of December 31, 2011.

 

F - 20


 


 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

(5)                                 PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT

 

Property, plant and equipment consisted of the following (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

 

 

Land and buildings

 

 $

38,846

 

 

 $

45,372

 

 

Computer equipment and software

 

261,378

 

 

245,333

 

 

Telephone equipment

 

44,861

 

 

45,743

 

 

Furniture and fixtures

 

51,460

 

 

54,364

 

 

Leasehold improvements

 

138,117

 

 

140,412

 

 

Motor vehicles

 

190

 

 

898

 

 

Construction-in-progress and other

 

339

 

 

1,768

 

 

Property, plant and equipment, gross

 

535,191

 

 

533,890

 

 

Less: Accumulated depreciation and amortization

 

(434,870

)

 

(428,362

)

 

Property, plant and equipment, net

 

 $

100,321

 

 

 $

105,528

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortization expense for property, plant and equipment was $40.4 million, $49.2 million and $55.9 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 

Included in computer equipment and software in the table above, the Company had $3.7 million and $2.7 million of unamortized Software Development Costs as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. Amortization expense for Software Development Costs was $1.0 million, $0.2 million and $0.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively, which is included in the depreciation and amortization expense for property, plant and equipment discussed above.

 

(6)                                 GOODWILL AND IMPAIRMENT

 

Goodwill consisted of the following (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

December 31,
2010

 

Acquisitions

 

Impairments

 

Effect of
Foreign
Currency

 

December 31,
2011

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

North American BPO

 

$

35,885   

 

$

18,516   

 

$

-   

 

$

-   

 

$

54,401   

 

International BPO

 

16,822   

 

44   

 

-   

 

(423)   

 

16,443   

 

Total

 

$

52,707   

 

$

18,560   

 

$

-   

 

$

(423)   

 

$

70,844   

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

December 31,
2009

 

Acquisitions

 

Impairments

 

Effect of
Foreign
Currency

 

December 31,
2010

 

North American BPO

 

$

35,885   

 

$

-   

 

$

-   

 

$

-   

 

$

35,885   

 

International BPO

 

9,365   

 

7,251   

 

-   

 

206   

 

16,822   

 

Total

 

$

45,250  

 

$

7,251   

 

$

-   

 

$

206   

 

$

52,707   

 

 

Impairment

 

The Company performs a goodwill impairment test on at least an annual basis. The Company conducts its annual goodwill impairment test during the fourth quarter, or more frequently, if indicators of impairment exist. As discussed in Note 2, the FASB amended its guidance to simplify testing goodwill for impairment. The amended guidance allows an entity to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether it is necessary to perform the two-step quantitative goodwill impairment test. If an entity determines that as a result of the qualitative assessment that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount, then the quantitative test is required. Otherwise, no further testing is required.

 

F - 21



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The Company has six reporting units with goodwill. The fair value of four of the Company’s reporting units was substantially in excess of its estimated carrying value as of the most recent quantitative analysis of goodwill impairment performed in the fourth quarter of 2010. There have been no triggering events or changes in circumstances since that quantitative analysis to indicate that the fair value of any of these reporting units would be less than their carrying amount. The Company performed a qualitative assessment of the goodwill by reporting unit in the fourth quarter 2011. In assessing the qualitative factors, the Company considered factors including but not limited to, economic, market and industry conditions, cost factors, changes in business strategy, earnings multiples, and budgeted-to-actual performance of revenue and gross margin from prior year. Based on this assessment, the Company concluded that it was more likely than not that the fair value of each of the four reporting units exceeded its carrying value. As such, it was not necessary to perform a quantitative impairment analysis, and the Company concluded that these reporting units were not impaired as of December 31, 2011 or 2010.

 

For the Company’s remaining reporting units, a quantitative assessment was performed. The quantitative assessment of goodwill includes comparing a reporting unit’s calculated fair value to its carrying value. The calculation of fair value requires significant judgments including estimation of future cash flows, which is dependent on internal forecasts, estimation of the long-term rate of growth for the businesses, the useful life over which cash flows will occur and determination of the Company’s weighted average cost of capital. Changes in these estimates and assumptions could materially affect the determination of fair value and/or conclusions on goodwill impairment for each reporting unit. As of December 31, 2011, the Company concluded that the fair value of each of the remaining reporting units was in excess of its carrying value and the goodwill in those reporting units was not impaired.

 

(7)                                 CONTRACT ACQUISITION COSTS

 

Contract acquisition costs, net consisted of the following (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

 

2011 

 

2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Contract acquisition costs, gross

 

$

  22,639 

 

$

30,710

 

Less: Accumulated amortization

 

 (19,773)

 

 (27,928)

 

Contract acquisition costs, net

 

$

  2,866 

 

$

  2,782

 

 

Amortization of contract acquisition costs recorded as a reduction to Revenue was $1.7 million, $5.3 million and $3.4 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 

Expected future amortization of contract acquisition costs as of December 31, 2011 is as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

2012 

 

$

  1,012

 

2013 

 

1,012

 

2014 

 

633

 

2015 

 

209

 

Total

 

$

  2,866

 

 

F - 22



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

(8)                                 OTHER INTANGIBLE ASSETS

 

Other intangible assets which are included in Other long-term assets in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets consisted of the following (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

December 31,
2010

 

Amortization
and
Impairment

 

 Acquisitions
or Disposals

 

Effect of
Foreign
Currency

 

December 31,
2011

 

Customer relationships, gross

 

$

  16,600 

 

$

  - 

 

11,700

 

(1,547)

 

$

  26,753

 

Customer relationships accumulated amortization

 

(3,371)

 

(2,318)

 

-

 

(262)

 

(5,951

)

Other intangible assets, gross

 

 

 

2,600

 

 

2,600

 

Other Intangible Assets accumulated amortization

 

 

(1,225)

 

-

 

 

(1,225

)

Trade name - indefinite life

 

8,200 

 

 

3,300

 

 

11,500

 

Other intangible assets, net

 

$

  21,429 

 

$

(3,543)

 

$

  17,600

 

$

(1,809)

 

$

  33,677

 

 

 

 

December 31,
2009

 

Amortization
and
Impairment

 

Acquisitions
or Disposals

 

Effect of
Foreign
Currency

 

December 31,
2010

 

Customer relationships, gross

 

$

7,300 

 

$

 

$

9,300

 

$

-

 

$

16,600

 

Customer relationships accumulated amortization

 

(2,555)

 

(816)

 

-

 

-

 

(3,371

)

Trade name - indefinite life

 

1,800 

 

 

6,400

 

-

 

8,200

 

Other intangible assets, net

 

$

6,545 

 

$

(816)

 

$

15,700

 

$

-

 

$

21,429

 

 

Customer relationships are being amortized over a weighted average useful life of 10.1 years and other intangible assets are being amortized over a weighted average useful life of 2.1 years. Amortization expense related to intangible assets was $3.5 million, $0.8 million and $1.1 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively. In the year ended 2009, the Company recognized $0.6 million in impairment losses related to its customer relationships intangible asset due to the loss of a significant customer in the International BPO segment. The impairment loss was equivalent to the remaining net carrying value of the particular asset at the time of the impairment.

 

Expected future amortization of other intangible assets as of December 31, 2011 is as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

2012 

 

$

 

3,382

 

2013 

 

3,007

 

2014 

 

2,978

 

2015 

 

2,664

 

2016 

 

2,299

 

Thereafter

 

7,847

 

Total

 

$

22,177

 

 

F - 23



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

(9)                                 DERIVATIVES

 

Cash Flow Hedges

 

The Company enters into foreign exchange and interest rate derivatives. Foreign exchange derivatives entered into consist of forward and option contracts to reduce the Company’s exposure to foreign currency exchange rate fluctuations that are associated with forecasted revenue earned in foreign locations. Interest rate derivatives consist of interest rate swaps to reduce the Company’s exposure to interest rate fluctuations associated with its variable rate debt. Upon proper qualification, these contracts are designated as cash flow hedges. It is the Company’s policy to only enter into derivative contracts with investment grade counterparty financial institutions, and correspondingly, the fair value of derivative assets consider, among other factors, the creditworthiness of these counterparties. Conversely, the fair value of derivative liabilities reflects the Company’s creditworthiness. As of December 31, 2011, the Company has not experienced, nor does it anticipate any issues related to derivative counterparty defaults. The following table summarizes the aggregate unrealized net gain or loss in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 (amounts in thousands and net of tax):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Aggregate unrealized net gain/(loss) at beginning of year

 

$

7,090

 

 

$

4,467

 

 

$

(21,180

)

Add: Net gain/(loss) from change in fair value of cash flow hedges

 

(7,362

)

 

8,513

 

 

14,427

 

Less: Net (gain)/loss reclassified to earnings from effective hedges

 

(5,580

)

 

(5,890

)

 

11,220

 

Aggregate unrealized net gain/(loss) at end of year

 

$

(5,852

)

 

$

7,090

 

 

$

4,467

 

 

The Company’s foreign exchange cash flow hedging instruments as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 are summarized as follows (amounts in thousands). All hedging instruments are forward contracts unless noted otherwise.

 

As of December 31, 2011

 

Local
Currency
Notional
Amount

 

U.S. Dollar
Notional
Amount

 

% Maturing
in 2012

 

Contracts
Maturing
Through

 

Canadian Dollar

 

25,750 

 

$

25,137 

 

69.9%

 

March 2014

 

Costa Rican Colon

 

2,000,000 

 

3,874 

 

100.0%

 

August 2012

 

Philippine Peso

 

13,304,000 

 

301,361 

(1)

56.3%

 

December 2014

 

Mexican Peso (Forwards)

 

1,081,000 

 

80,735 

 

47.7%

 

November 2014

 

Mexican Peso (Collars)

 

140,298 

 

12,000 

(3)

100.0%

 

December 2012

 

British Pound Sterling

 

8,808 

 

13,822 

(2)

60.1%

 

June 2014

 

 

 

 

 

$

436,929 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2010

 

Local
Currency
Notional
Amount

 

U.S. Dollar
Notional
Amount

 

 

 

 

 

Canadian Dollar

 

10,200  

 

$

 8,493 

 

 

 

 

 

Philippine Peso

 

7,731,000  

 

169,364 

(1)

 

 

 

 

Mexican Peso

 

311,500  

 

22,383 

 

 

 

 

 

British Pound Sterling

 

4,647  

 

7,231 

(2)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

207,471 

 

 

 

 

 

 

F - 24



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

(1)              Includes contracts to purchase Philippine pesos in exchange for New Zealand dollars and Australian dollars, which are translated into equivalent U.S. dollars on  December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.

(2)              Includes contracts to purchase British pound sterling in exchange for Euros, which are translated into equivalent U.S. dollars on December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.

(3)              The Mexican peso collars include call options with a floor total of MXN 140,298 and put options with a cap total of MXN 157,038.

 

The Company’s interest rate swap arrangements as of December 31, 2011 were as follows:

 

 

 

Notional
Amount

 

 

Variable Rate
Received

 

 

Fixed Rate
Paid

 

 

Contract
Commencement
Date

 

 

Contract
Maturity
Date

 

As of December 31, 2011

 

$

25 million

 

 

1 - month LIBOR

 

 

2.55    %

 

 

April 2012

 

 

April 2016

 

 

 

 

15 million

 

 

1 - month LIBOR

 

 

3.14    %

 

 

May 2012

 

 

May 2017

 

 

 

$

40 million

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

The Company did not have any interest rate swap arrangements as of December 31, 2010.

 

Hedge of Net Investment

 

In 2008, the Company entered into a foreign exchange forward contract to hedge its net investment in a foreign operation which was settled in May 2009. Changes in fair value of the Company’s net investment hedge are recorded in the cumulative translation adjustment in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets offsetting the change in the cumulative translation adjustment attributable to the hedged portion of the Company’s net investment in the foreign operation. Gains and losses from the settlements of the Company’s net investment hedge remain in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) until partial or complete liquidation of the applicable net investment. A loss of $1.2 million from the settlements of net investment hedges was recorded within Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) at December 31, 2011.

 

Fair Value Hedges

 

The Company enters into foreign exchange forward contracts to hedge against foreign currency exchange gains and losses on certain receivables and payables of the Company’s foreign operations. Changes in the fair value of derivative instruments designated as fair value hedges, as well as the offsetting gain or loss on the hedged asset or liability, are recognized in earnings in Other income (expense), net. As of December 31, 2011, the total notional amount of the Company’s forward contracts used as fair value hedges was $49.8 million.

 

Embedded Derivatives

 

In addition to hedging activities, the Company’s foreign subsidiary in Argentina was party to U.S. dollar denominated lease contracts which the Company determined contained embedded derivatives. As such, the Company bifurcated the embedded derivatives features of the lease contracts and valued these features as foreign currency derivatives. In 2011, the Company amended its leases reducing the fair value to zero as of December 31, 2011.

 

F - 25



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Derivative Valuation and Settlements

 

The Company’s derivatives as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 were as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

December 31, 2011

 

 

 

Designated as hedging
instruments

 

Not Designated as Hedging
Instruments

 

Derivative contracts:

 

Foreign
Exchange

 

Interest
Rate

 

Foreign
Exchange

 

Leases

 

Derivative classification:

 

Cash Flow

 

Cash Flow

 

Fair Value

 

Embedded
Derivative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair value and location of derivative in the Consolidated Balance Sheet:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Prepaids and other current assets

 

$

2,325 

 

$

 

$

12 

 

$

-

 

Other long-term assets

 

1,119 

 

 

 

-

 

Other current liabilities

 

(7,828)

 

 

(341)

 

-

 

Other long-term liabilities

 

(2,786)

 

(2,263)

 

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total fair value of derivatives, net

 

$

(7,170)

 

$

(2,263)

 

$

(329)

 

$

-

 

 

 

 

December 31, 2010

 

 

 

Designated as hedging
instruments

 

Not designated as hedging
instruments

 

Derivative contracts:

 

Foreign
Exchange

 

Interest
Rate

 

Foreign
Exchange

 

Leases

 

Derivative classification:

 

Cash Flow

 

Cash Flow

 

Fair Value

 

Embedded
Derivative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair value and location of derivative in the Consolidated Balance Sheet:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Prepaids and other current assets

 

$

10,602 

 

$

-

 

$

783 

 

$

-

 

Other long-term assets

 

2,081 

 

-

 

 

-

 

Other current liabilities

 

(677)

 

-

 

(58)

 

(105)

 

Other long-term liabilities

 

(104)

 

-

 

 

(34)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total fair value of derivatives, net

 

$

11,902 

 

$

-

 

$

725 

 

$

(139)

 

 

F - 26



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The effect of derivative instruments on the Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income for the year ended December 31, 2011 and 2010 were as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

 

 

Designated as hedging instruments

 

Designated as hedging instruments

 

Derivative contracts:

 

Foreign
Exchange

 

Interest
Rate

 

Foreign
Exchange

 

Interest
Rate

 

Derivative classification:

 

Cash Flow

 

Cash Flow

 

Cash Flow

 

Cash Flow

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amount of gain or (loss) recognized in other comprehensive income - effective portion, net of tax:

 

$

(6,003)   

 

$

(1,358)   

 

$

8,513   

 

$

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amount and location of net gain or (loss) reclassified from accumulated OCI to income - effective portion:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue

 

$

9,297   

 

$

-

 

$

9,817   

 

$

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amount and location of net gain or (loss) reclassified from accumulated OCI to income - ineffective portion and amount excluded from effectiveness testing:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other income (expense), net

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivative contracts:

 

Not designated as hedging instruments

 

Not designated as hedging instruments

 

 

 

Foreign Exchange

 

Leases

 

Foreign Exchange

 

Leases

 

Derivative classification:

 

Option and
Forward
Contracts

 

Fair Value

 

Embedded
Derivative

 

Option and
Forward
Contracts

 

Fair Value

 

Embedded
Derivative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amount and location of net gain or (loss) recognized in the Consolidated Statement of Operations:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cost of services

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

$

139

 

$

-

 

$

-

 

$

230

 

Other income (expense), net

 

  -

 

  (1,178)

 

 -

 

   (42)

 

3,693

 

-

 

 

(10)                          FAIR VALUE

 

The authoritative guidance for fair value measurements establishes a three-level fair value hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs used to measure fair value. This hierarchy requires that the Company maximize the use of observable inputs and minimize the use of unobservable inputs. The three levels of inputs used to measure fair value are as follows:

 

Level 1 —

 

Quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.

 

 

 

Level 2 —

 

Observable inputs other than quoted prices included in Level 1, such as quoted prices for similar assets and liabilities in active markets, similar assets and liabilities in markets that are not active or can be corroborated by observable market data.

 

 

 

Level 3 —

 

Unobservable inputs that are supported by little or no market activity and that are significant to the fair value of the assets or liabilities. This includes certain pricing models, discounted cash flow methodologies and similar techniques that use significant unobservable inputs.

 

F - 27



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The following presents information as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 of the Company’s assets and liabilities required to be measured at fair value on a recurring basis, as well as the fair value hierarchy used to determine their fair value.

 

Accounts Receivable and Payable - The amounts recorded in the accompanying balance sheets approximate fair value because of their short-term nature.

 

Debt - The Company’s debt consists primarily of the Company’s Credit Agreement, which permits floating-rate borrowings based upon the current Prime Rate or LIBOR plus a credit spread as determined by the Company’s leverage ratio calculation (as defined in the Credit Agreement). As of December 31, 2011, the Company had $64.0 million of borrowings outstanding under the Credit Agreement. During 2011, borrowings accrued interest at an average rate of 1.6% per annum, excluding unused commitment fees. As of December 31, 2010 the Company had no borrowings outstanding under the Credit Agreement. The amounts recorded in the accompanying balance sheets approximate fair value due to the variable nature of the debt.

 

Derivatives - Net derivative assets (liabilities) are measured at fair value on a recurring basis. The portfolio is valued using models based on market observable inputs, including both forward and spot foreign exchange rates, interest rates, implied volatility, and counterparty credit risk, including the ability of each party to execute its obligations under the contract. As of December 31, 2011, credit risk did not materially change the fair value of the Company’s derivative contracts.

 

The following is a summary of the Company’s fair value measurements for its net derivative assets (liabilities) as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 (amounts in thousands):

 

As of December 31, 2011

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair Value Measurements Using

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Quoted Prices in
Active Markets
for Identical
Assets

 

Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs

 

Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

 

 

 

 

 

(Level 1)

 

(Level 2)

 

(Level 3)

 

At Fair Value

 

Cash flow hedges

 

$

-

 

$

(7,170)

 

$

-

 

$

(7,170)

 

Interest rate swaps

 

-

 

(2,263)

 

-

 

(2,263)

 

Fair value hedges

 

-

 

(329)

 

-

 

(329)

 

Embedded derivatives

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Total net derivative asset (liability)

 

$

-

 

$

(9,762)

 

$

-

 

$

(9,762)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair Value Measurements Using

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Quoted Prices in
Active Markets
for Identical
Assets

 

Significant
Other
Observable
Inputs

 

Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

 

 

 

 

 

(Level 1)

 

(Level 2)

 

(Level 3)

 

At Fair Value

 

Cash flow hedges

 

$

-

 

$

11,902

 

$

-

 

$

11,902

 

Interest rate swaps

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Fair value hedges

 

-

 

725

 

-

 

725

 

Embedded derivatives

 

-

 

(139)

 

-

 

(139)

 

Total net derivative asset (liability)

 

$

-

 

$

12,488

 

$

-

 

$

12,488

 

 

F - 28



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The following is a summary of the Company’s fair value measurement as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 (amounts in thousands):

 

As of December 31, 2011

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair Value Measurements Using

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Quoted Prices in
Active Markets for
Identical Assets

 

Significant Other
Observable Inputs

 

Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

 

 

 

(Level 1)

 

(Level 2)

 

(Level 3)

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Money market investments

 

$

-

 

$

507

 

$

-

 

Derivative instruments, net

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Total assets

 

$

-

 

$

507

 

$

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferred compensation plan liability

 

$

-

 

$

(3,990)

 

$

-

 

Derivative instruments, net

 

-

 

(9,762)

 

-

 

Purchase price payable

 

-

 

-

 

(4,985)

 

Total liabilities

 

$

-

 

$

(13,752)

 

$

(4,985)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As of December 31, 2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair Value Measurements Using

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Quoted Prices in
Active Markets for
Identical Assets

 

Significant Other
Observable Inputs

 

Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

 

 

 

(Level 1)

 

(Level 2)

 

(Level 3)

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Money market investments

 

$

-

 

$

19,668

 

$

-

 

Derivative instruments, net

 

-

 

12,488

 

-

 

Total assets

 

$

-

 

$

32,156

 

$

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferred compensation plan liability

 

$

-

 

$

(3,781)

 

$

-

 

Purchase price payable

 

-

 

-

 

(4,506)

 

Total liabilities

 

$

-

 

$

(3,781)

 

$

(4,506)

 

 

Money Market Investments - The Company invests in various well-diversified money market funds which are managed by financial institutions. These money market funds are not publicly traded, but have historically been highly liquid. The value of the money market funds are determined by the banks based upon the funds’ net asset values (“NAV”). All of the money market funds currently permit daily investments and redemptions at a $1.00 NAV.

 

Deferred Compensation Plan - The Company maintains a non-qualified deferred compensation plan structured as a Rabbi trust for certain eligible employees. Participants in the deferred compensation plan select from a menu of phantom investment options for their deferral dollars offered by the Company each year, which are based upon changes in value of complementary, defined market investments. The deferred compensation liability represents the combined values of market investments against which participant accounts are tracked.

 

F - 29



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Purchase Price PayableThe Company has a future payable related to the purchase of PRG discussed in Note 2. As part of the PRG acquisition, the Company will pay $5.0 million on March 1, 2012. This payment was recognized at fair value using a discounted cash flow approach and a discount rate of 18.4%. This measurement is based on significant inputs not observable in the market. The Company will record accretion expense each period using the effective interest rate method until the payable reaches $5.0 million on March 1, 2012. Accretion expense related to the PRG purchase price payable is included in Interest expense in the Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income.

 

(11)                          INCOME TAXES

 

The sources of pre-tax accounting income are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

Domestic

 

$

3,225

 

$

19,891

 

$

34,791

 

Foreign

 

88,329

 

62,078

 

68,252

 

Total

 

$

91,554

 

$

81,969

 

$

103,043

 

 

The components of the Company’s Provision for income taxes are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

Current provision

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal

 

$

(10,371)

 

$

9,612

 

$

7,751

 

State

 

297

 

1,391

 

(317)

 

Foreign

 

21,695

 

20,458

 

13,977

 

Total current provision

 

11,621

 

31,461

 

21,411

 

Deferred provision (benefit)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Federal

 

(838)

 

(128)

 

7,027

 

State

 

(44)

 

(17)

 

460

 

Foreign

 

2,540

 

(2,885)

 

(1,421)

 

Total deferred provision (benefit)

 

1,658

 

(3,030)

 

6,066

 

Total provision for income taxes

 

$

13,279

 

$

28,431

 

$

27,477

 

 

F - 30



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The following reconciles the Company’s effective tax rate to the federal statutory rate (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

 

2009

 

Income tax per U.S. federal statutory rate (35%)

 

$

32,044

 

 

$

28,689

 

 

$

 36,084 

 

State income taxes, net of federal deduction

 

875

 

 

2,079

 

 

1,015 

 

Change in valuation allowances

 

(79

)

 

5,645

 

 

(2,855)

 

Foreign income taxes at different rates than the U.S.

 

(18,136

)

 

(12,499

)

 

(12,812)

 

Foreign withholding taxes

 

2,177

 

 

989

 

 

3,402 

 

Increase to current/deferred tax assets due to implementation of tax planning strategies

 

-

 

 

(4,910

)

 

 

Losses in international markets without tax benefits

 

1,094

 

 

964

 

 

856 

 

Nondeductible compensation under Section 162(m)

 

2,408

 

 

1,002

 

 

1,162 

 

Liabilities for uncertain tax positions

 

1,875

 

 

(2,695

)

 

401 

 

Permanent difference related to foreign exchange gains

 

(45

)

 

(46

)

 

(110)

 

(Income)/losses of foreign branch operations

 

70

 

 

2,340

 

 

(78)

 

Non-taxable earnings of minority interest

 

390

 

 

(603

)

 

(434)

 

Foreign dividend less foreign tax credits

 

(5,294

)

 

5,344

 

 

 

Increase in deferred tax liability - branch losses in UK

 

18

 

 

2,586

 

 

 

Increase to deferred tax asset - change in state tax rate

 

-

 

 

(588

)

 

 

IRS settlement on prior year refund claims

 

(11,700

)

 

-

 

 

 

Canada CRA tax decision

 

8,680

 

 

-

 

 

 

Other

 

(1,098

)

 

134

 

 

846 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income tax per effective tax rate

 

$

13,279

 

 

$

28,431

 

 

$

 27,477 

 

 

F - 31



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The Company’s deferred income tax assets and liabilities are summarized as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

Deferred tax assets, gross

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accrued workers compensation, deferred compensation and employee benefits

 

$

4,720

 

 

$

2,337 

 

Allowance for doubtful accounts, insurance and other accruals

 

6,017

 

 

8,402 

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

8,377

 

 

12,579 

 

Amortization of deferred rent liabilities

 

1,472

 

 

2,624 

 

Net operating losses

 

15,932

 

 

19,126 

 

Equity compensation

 

7,389

 

 

7,010 

 

Customer acquisition and deferred revenue accruals

 

10,252

 

 

1,905 

 

Federal and state tax credits, net

 

15,965

 

 

18,450 

 

Contract acquisition costs

 

-

 

 

241 

 

Unrealized losses on derivatives

 

2,679

 

 

 

Other

 

11,284

 

 

5,431 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets, gross

 

84,087

 

 

78,105 

 

Valuation allowances

 

(16,555

)

 

(22,636)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total deferred tax assets, net

 

67,532

 

 

55,469 

 

Deferred tax liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

Long-term lease obligations

 

(23

)

 

(28)

 

Unrealized gains on derivatives

 

-

 

 

(4,810)

 

Contract acquisition costs

 

(6,015

)

 

 

Future losses in UK

 

(4,571

)

 

(4,554)

 

Other

 

(5,349

)

 

(5,157)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total deferred tax liabilities

 

(15,958

)

 

(14,549)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net deferred tax assets

 

$

51,574

 

 

$

40,920 

 

 

The Company periodically reviews the likelihood that deferred tax assets will be realized in future tax periods under the “more likely than not” criteria. In making this judgment, the Company evaluates all available evidence, both positive and negative, to determine whether, based on the weight of that evidence, a valuation allowance is required.

 

As of December 31, 2011 the Company had approximately $42.2 million of net deferred tax assets in the U.S. and $25.9 million of net deferred tax assets related to certain international locations whose recoverability is dependent upon their future profitability. As of December 31, 2011 the deferred tax valuation allowance was $16.6 million and related primarily to tax losses in foreign jurisdictions and U.S. federal and state tax credits which do not meet the “more-likely-than-not” standard under current accounting guidance. The utilization of these state tax credits are subject to numerous factors including various expiration dates, generation of future taxable income over extended periods of time and state income tax apportionment factors which are subject to change.

 

When there is a change in judgment concerning the recovery of deferred tax assets in future periods, a valuation allowance is recorded into earnings during the quarter in which the change in judgment occurred. In 2011, the Company made adjustments to its deferred tax assets and corresponding valuation allowances. The net reduction to the valuation allowance of $6.1 million was due to a $3.7 million decrease in certain state credits and NOLs that do not meet the “more-likely-than-not” standard; a $2.4 million decrease due to the dissolution of South Africa, a $0.8 million increase in valuation allowance in Spain for deferred tax assets that do not meet the “more-likely-than-not” standard; a $1.3 million decrease in the valuation allowance related to certain federal tax credits; and a $0.5 million increase in the valuation allowance in certain other foreign jurisdictions.

 

F - 32



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

On February 20, 2011, the Company received notice of an adverse decision by the Canadian Revenue Agency (“CRA”) in regards to the Company’s attempt to recover taxes paid to Canada with respect to the years 2001 and 2002. In 2005, through the Competent Authority process, the Company sought relief under the United States-Canada Income Tax Convention for avoidance of double taxation arising from adjustments to the taxable income originally reported to these jurisdictions. Consistent with accounting for tax positions that no longer meet the recognition criteria, the Company derecognized income tax positions totaling $8.6 million through income tax expense in the first quarter of 2011. The Company continues to believe in the merits of its claim for which it sought relief from double taxation through the Competent Authority process. In response the Company has filed for Judicial Review in the Federal Court of Canada seeking a writ of mandamus to compel the CRA to accept the Company’s application for Competent Authority consideration.

 

On December 20, 2011, the Company received written notice from the Internal Revenue Service that the Joint Committee on Taxation has completed its consideration of the mediated settlement reached with the IRS concerning tax refund claims and taken no exception to the conclusions reached. During 2011, the Company recognized, as a reduction to income tax expense, income tax positions (including interest net of tax) of $11.7 million related to these claims. The Company expects to collect these refunds during the first quarter of 2012.

 

As of December 31, 2011, after consideration of all tax loss and tax credit carry back opportunities, the Company had net tax loss carry forwards expiring as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

2012

 

$

45

 

2013

 

359

 

2014

 

4,047

 

2015

 

4,834

 

2016

 

10,329

 

After 2016

 

17,811

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

$

37,425

 

 

As of December 31, 2011, domestically, the Company had federal tax credit carry forwards in the amount of $6.1 million that if unused will expire in 2020 and $4.7 million that if unused will expire in 2021. The Company also had state tax credit carry-forwards of $5.2 million that if unused will expire between 2012 and 2023.

 

As of December 31, 2011 the cumulative amount of foreign earnings considered permanently invested outside the U.S. was $223.1 million. Those earnings do not include earnings from certain subsidiaries which the Company intends to repatriate to the U.S. or are otherwise considered available for distribution to the U.S. Accordingly, no provision for U.S. federal or state income taxes or foreign withholding taxes has been provided on these undistributed earnings. If these earnings become taxable in the U.S, the Company would be subject to incremental tax expense, after any applicable foreign tax credit, and foreign withholding tax expense. It is not practicable to estimate the additional taxes that may become payable upon the eventual remittance of these foreign earnings.

 

The Company has been granted “Tax Holidays” as an incentive to attract foreign investment by the governments of the Philippines and Costa Rica. Generally, a Tax Holiday is an agreement between the Company and a foreign government under which the Company receives certain tax benefits in that country, such as exemption from taxation on profits derived from export-related activities. In the Philippines, the Company has been granted 14 separate agreements with an initial period of four years and additional periods for varying years, expiring at various times between 2011 and 2013. The aggregate effect on income tax expense for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was approximately $14.0 million, $7.6 million and $8.9 million, respectively, which had a favorable impact on diluted net income per share of $0.25, $0.13 and $0.14, respectively.

 

F - 33



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes

 

In accordance with ASC 740, the Company has recorded a reserve for uncertain tax positions. The total amount of interest and penalties recognized in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income as of December 31, 2011, 2010 and December 31, 2009 was approximately $0.1 million $0.1 million and $0.1 million, respectively, and the total amount of interest and penalties recognized in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 was approximately $0.6 million and $0.5 million, respectively.

 

The Company had a reserve for uncertain tax benefits, on a net basis, of $3.3 million and $9.0 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. The liability for uncertain tax positions was reduced by $0.4 million for tax positions that were resolved favorably or expired. It was also reduced by $8.1 million on account of new information used in the measurement of an unrecognized tax benefit.

 

The tabular reconciliation of the reserve for uncertain tax benefits on a gross basis for the year ended December 31, 2011 is presented below (amounts in thousands):

 

Balance as of December 31, 2008

 

$

21,918

 

Additions for current year tax positions

 

352

 

Reductions in prior year tax positions

 

(238

)

 

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2009

 

 

22,032

 

Additions for current year tax positions

 

28

 

Reductions in prior year tax positions

 

(13,025

)

 

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2010

 

 

9,035

 

Additions for current year tax positions

 

2,202

 

Reductions in prior year tax positions

 

(8,502

)

 

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2011

 

$

2,735

 

 

At December 31, 2011, the amount of uncertain tax benefits that, if recognized, would reduce tax expense was $2.7 million. Within the next 12 months, it is reasonably possible that unrecognized tax benefits may decrease by $0.5 million as the result of the expiration of various statutes of limitation.

 

The Company and its domestic and foreign subsidiaries (including Percepta LLC and its domestic and foreign subsidiaries) file income tax returns as required in the U.S. federal jurisdiction and various state and foreign jurisdictions. The following table presents the major tax jurisdictions and tax years that are open as of December 31, 2011 and subject to examination by the respective tax authorities:

 

Tax Jurisdiction

 

Tax Year Ended

 

United States

 

2002 to 2004 and 2008 to present

 

Argentina

 

2006 to present

 

Australia

 

2006 to present

 

Brazil

 

2003 to present

 

Canada

 

2005 to present

 

Mexico

 

2006 to present

 

Philippines

 

2008 to present

 

Spain

 

2007 to present

 

 

The Company’s U.S. income tax returns filed for the tax years ending December 31, 2002 through 2004, and 2008 to present, remain open tax years subject to IRS audit. The Company has been notified of the intent to audit, or is currently under audit of income taxes in the Philippines. Although the outcome of examinations by taxing authorities are always uncertain, it is the opinion of management that the resolution of these audits will not have a material effect on the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

F - 34



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

(12)       RESTRUCTURING CHARGES AND IMPAIRMENT LOSSES

 

Restructuring Charges

 

During the years ended December 31, 2011, December 31, 2010 and 2009, the Company undertook a number of restructuring activities primarily associated with reductions in the Company’s capacity and workforce in both the North American BPO and International BPO segments to better align the capacity and workforce with current business needs.

 

A summary of the expenses recorded in Restructuring, net in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income (Loss) for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively, is as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

 

2009

 

North American BPO

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Reduction in force

 

 

$

2,665

 

 

$

7,891

 

 

$

4,008

 

Facility exit charges

 

 

74

 

 

320

 

 

408

 

Changes in estimates

 

 

(381

)

 

(5

)

 

(1,028

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

 

$

2,358

 

 

$

8,206

 

 

$

3,388

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

 

2009

 

International BPO

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Reduction in force

 

 

$

1,268

 

 

$

5,189

 

 

$

1,516

 

Facility exit charges

 

 

-

 

 

89

 

 

168

 

Changes in estimates

 

 

25

 

 

(8

)

 

-

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

 

$

1,293

 

 

$

5,270

 

 

$

1,684

 

 

A rollforward of the activity in the Company’s restructuring accruals for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, is as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Closure of
Delivery
Centers

 

 

Reduction
in Force

 

 

Total

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2009

 

$

375

 

 

$

13

 

 

$

388

 

Expense

 

409

 

 

13,080

 

 

13,489

 

Payments

 

(89

)

 

(4,813

)

 

(4,902

)

Changes in estimates

 

 

-

 

 

 

(13

)

 

 

(13

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2010

 

695

 

 

8,267

 

 

8,962

 

Expense

 

74

 

 

3,933

 

 

4,007

 

Payments

 

(354

)

 

(10,192

)

 

(10,546

)

Changes in estimates

 

-

 

 

(356

)

 

(356

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance as of December 31, 2011

 

$

415

 

 

$

1,652

 

 

$

2,067

 

 

F - 35



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The remaining restructuring accruals are expected to be paid or extinguished during 2012 and are all classified as current liabilities within Accrued employee compensation and benefits in the Consolidated Balance Sheet.

 

Impairment Losses

 

During each of the periods presented, the Company evaluated the recoverability of its leasehold improvement assets at certain delivery centers. An asset is considered to be impaired when the anticipated undiscounted future cash flows of an asset group are estimated to be less than the asset group’s carrying value. The amount of impairment recognized is the difference between the carrying value of the asset group and its fair value. To determine fair value, the Company used Level 3 inputs in its discounted cash flows analysis. Assumptions included the amount and timing of estimated future cash flows and assumed discount rates. During 2011, the Company recognized impairment losses related to leasehold improvement assets of $0.2 million in its International BPO segment.

 

During 2010, the Company recognized impairment losses of $1.4 million in its North American BPO segment and $0.6 million in its International BPO segment based on the Company’s evaluation of the recoverability of its leasehold improvement assets.

 

During 2009, the Company recognized impairment losses of $2.8 million in its International BPO segment, related to the exiting of $2.0 million of certain delivery centers and an $0.8 million impairment loss based on the Company’s evaluation of the recoverability of its leasehold improvement and other intangible assets. During 2009, the Company recognized impairment losses of $1.8 million in its North American BPO segment based on the Company’s evaluation of the recoverability of its leasehold improvement assets.

 

(13)       INDEBTEDNESS

 

Credit Facility

 

On October 1, 2010, the Company entered into a credit agreement (the “Credit Agreement”) with a syndicate of lenders led by KeyBank National Association, Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, Bank of America, N.A., BBVA Compass, and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A. The Credit Agreement amended and restated in its entirety the Company’s prior credit facility entered into during 2006. The five-year, $350.0 million revolving credit facility with expanded foreign borrower and multi-currency flexibility also includes a $150.0 million accordion provision providing an option to increase the aggregate commitment to $500.0 million.

 

The Credit Agreement provides for a secured revolving credit facility that matures on September 30, 2015 with an initial maximum aggregate commitment of $350.0 million. At the Company’s discretion, direct borrowing options under the Credit Agreement include (i) Eurodollar loans with one, two, three, and six month terms, and/or (ii) overnight base rate loans. The Credit Agreement also provides for a sub-limit for loans or letters of credit in both U.S. dollars and certain foreign currencies, with direct foreign subsidiary borrowing capabilities up to 50% of the total commitment amount. The Company may increase the maximum aggregate commitment under the Credit Agreement to $500.0 million if certain conditions are satisfied, including that the Company is not in default under the Credit Agreement at the time of the increase and that the Company obtains the commitment of the lenders participating in the increase.

 

Base rate loans bear interest at a rate equal to the greatest of (i) KeyBank National Association’s prime rate, (ii) the federal funds effective rate plus 0.5% or (iii) the one month London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”) plus 1.25%, in each case adding a margin based upon the Company’s leverage ratio. Eurodollar and alternate currency loans bear interest based upon LIBOR, as adjusted for prescribed bank reserves, plus a margin based upon the Company’s leverage ratio. Letter of credit fees are 0.125% of the stated amount of the letter of credit on the date of issuance, renewal or amendment, plus an annual fee equal to the borrowing margin for Eurodollar loans. Facility fees are payable to the lenders in an amount equal to the unused portion of the credit facility and are based upon the Company’s leverage ratio.

 

F - 36



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Indebtedness under the Credit Agreement is guaranteed by certain of the Company’s present and future domestic subsidiaries. Indebtedness under the Credit Agreement and the related guarantees are secured by security interests (subject to permitted liens) in the U.S. accounts receivable and cash of the Company and certain of its domestic subsidiaries and may be secured by tangible assets of the Company and such domestic subsidiaries if borrowings by foreign subsidiaries exceed $50.0 million and the leverage ratio is greater than 2.50 to 1.00. The Company also pledged 65% of the voting stock and 100% of the non-voting stock of certain of the Company’s material foreign subsidiaries and may pledge 65% of the voting stock and 100% of the non-voting stock of the Company’s other foreign subsidiaries.

 

The Company primarily utilizes its Credit Agreement to fund working capital, general operations, stock repurchases and other strategic activities, such as the acquisitions described in Note 2. As of December 31, 2011, and 2010, the Company had borrowings of $64.0 million and zero, respectively, under its Credit Agreement, and its average daily utilization was $112.4 million and $62.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively. After consideration for issued letters of credit under the Credit Agreement, totaling $4.5 million, the Company’s remaining borrowing capacity was $281.5 million as of December 31, 2011. As of December 31, 2011, the Company was in compliance with all covenants and conditions under its Credit Agreement.

 

From time-to-time, the Company has unsecured, uncommitted lines of credit to support working capital for a few foreign subsidiaries. As of December 31, 2011, no foreign loans were outstanding.  As of December 31, 2010, only one loan was outstanding for approximately $0.6 million, which was included in Other current liabilities in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets. The line of credit accrued interest at 6.0% per annum.

 

(14)       DEFERRED REVENUE AND COSTS

 

Deferred revenue in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets consist of the following (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

Deferred Revenue - Current

 

$

15,895

 

 

$

5,570

 

Deferred Revenue - Long-term

 

13,976

 

 

2,980

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Deferred Revenue

 

$

29,871

 

 

$

8,550

 

 

Activity for the Company’s Deferred revenue was as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

 

2009

 

Balance, beginning of year

 

$

8,550

 

 

$

15,667

 

 

$

16,908 

 

Add: Amounts deferred due to new business

 

67,058

 

 

8,761

 

 

23,513 

 

Less: Revenue recognized

 

(45,741

)

 

(15,962

)

 

(25,388)

 

Net increase/(decrease) in deferred revenue

 

21,317

 

 

(7,201

)

 

(1,875)

 

Effect of foreign currency

 

4

 

 

84

 

 

634 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

 

$

29,871

 

 

$

8,550

 

 

$

15,667 

 

 

Deferred costs in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets consist of the following (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

Deferred Costs - Current

 

$

8,574

 

 

$

1,135

 

Deferred Costs - Long-term

 

10,030

 

 

3,598

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total Deferred Costs

 

$

18,604

 

 

$

4,733

 

 

F - 37



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Activity for the Company’s Deferred costs was as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

 

2010

 

 

2009

 

 

Balance, beginning of year

 

$

4,733

 

 

$

4,873

 

 

$

8,389

 

 

Add: Amounts deferred due to new business

 

24,569

 

 

4,476

 

 

7,180

 

 

Less: Recognized expense

 

(10,701

)

 

(4,636

)

 

(10,657

)

 

Net increase/(decrease) in deferred costs

 

13,868

 

 

(160

)

 

(3,477

)

 

Effect of foreign currency

 

3

 

 

20

 

 

(39

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance, end of year

 

$

18,604

 

 

$

4,733

 

 

$

4,873

 

 

 

(15)       COMMITMENTS AND CONTINGENCIES

 

Letters of Credit

 

As of December 31, 2011, outstanding letters of credit under the Credit Agreement totaled $4.5 million and primarily guaranteed workers’ compensation and other insurance-related obligations.  As of December 31, 2011, letters of credit and contract performance guarantees issued outside of the Credit Agreement totaled $1.3 million.

 

Guarantees

 

The Company’s Credit Facility is guaranteed by certain of the Company’s domestic subsidiaries.

 

On March 31, 2010, the Company sold a corporate aircraft that was financed under a synthetic operating lease. Accordingly, the Company elected to exercise its purchase option rights under the lease for a specified amount.  Simultaneous with the purchase, the Company sold the aircraft to an unrelated third-party. The proceeds from the aircraft sale were used to satisfy the lease obligations and other sales-related expenses, with the Company realizing a net gain of approximately $137,000, which was recorded in Other income (expense), net in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income during 2010.

 

Legal Proceedings

 

From time to time, we have been involved in claims and lawsuits, both as plaintiff and defendant, which arise in the ordinary course of business. Accruals for claims or lawsuits have been provided for to the extent that losses are deemed both probable and estimable. Although the ultimate outcome of these claims or lawsuits cannot be ascertained, on the basis of present information and advice received from counsel, we believe that the disposition or ultimate resolution of such claims or lawsuits will not have a material adverse effect on our financial position, cash flows or results of operations.

 

(16)       LEASES

 

The Company has various operating leases primarily for equipment, delivery centers and office space, which generally contain renewal options. Rent expense under operating leases was approximately $30.0 million, $30.2 million and $29.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 

In 2008, the Company sub-leased one of its delivery centers to a third party for the remaining term of the original lease. The sub-lease began on January 1, 2009 and rental income received over the term of the lease will be recognized on a straight-line basis. Future minimum sub-lease rental receipts are shown in the table below.

 

F - 38



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The future minimum rental payments and receipts required under non-cancelable operating leases as of December 31, 2011 are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

 

Operating
Leases

 

 

 

Sub-Lease
Income

 

2012

 

 

$

24,731

 

 

 

$

1,823

 

2013

 

 

20,897

 

 

 

1,823

 

2014

 

 

14,339

 

 

 

1,823

 

2015

 

 

6,473

 

 

 

2,234

 

2016

 

 

4,059

 

 

 

2,234

 

Thereafter

 

 

5,729

 

 

 

9,849

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

 

$

76,228

 

 

 

$

19,786

 

 

In addition, the Company records operating lease expense on a straight-line basis over the life of the lease as described in Note 1. The deferred lease liability as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 was $6.7 million and $10.4 million, respectively.

 

The future minimum rental payments for capital leases as of December 31, 2011 are as follows (amounts in thousands) and the current portion and the long-term portion of the obligation are included in the Other current liabilities in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets:

 

 

 

 

Capital
Leases

 

Future rental payments

 

 

$

366

 

Less amount representing interest

 

 

(11

)

Present value of minimum lease payments

 

 

355

 

Less current portion

 

 

(355

)

 

 

 

 

 

Long-term portion

 

 

$

-

 

 

The Company has two delivery centers classified as capital leases at December 31, 2011. The amounts applicable to these leases included in property, plant and equipment are as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

 

 

2011

 

 

 

2010

 

Historical cost

 

 

$

12,181

 

 

 

$

12,181

 

Less: Accumulated depreciation

 

 

(12,181

)

 

 

(11,871

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

-

 

 

 

$

310

 

 

F - 39



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Asset Retirement Obligations

 

The Company records asset retirement obligations for its delivery center leases. Capitalized costs related to asset retirement obligations are included in Other long-term assets in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets while the asset retirement obligation (“ARO”) liability is included in Other long-term liabilities in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets. Following is a summary of the amounts recorded (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Balance at
December 31,
2010

 

 

Additions and
Modifications

 

 

Accretion

 

 

Settlements

 

 

Balance at
December 31,
2011

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ARO liability at inception

 

$

1,645

 

 

$

278

 

 

$

-

 

 

$

(512

)

 

$

1,411

 

Accumulated accretion

 

655

 

 

9

 

 

 

23

 

 

 

(16

)

 

671

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

2,300

 

 

$

287

 

 

$

23

 

 

$

(528

)

 

$

2,082

 

 

 

 

Balance at
December 31,
2009

 

 

Additions and
Modifications

 

 

Accretion

 

 

Settlements

 

 

Balance at
December 31,
2010

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ARO liability at inception

 

$

1,798

 

 

$

406

 

 

$

-

 

 

$

(559

)

 

$

1,645

 

Accumulated accretion

 

805

 

 

-

 

 

82

 

 

(232

)

 

655

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$

2,603

 

 

$

406

 

 

$

82

 

 

$

(791

)

 

$

2,300

 

 

Increases to ARO result from a new lease agreement or modifications on an ARO from a preexisting lease agreement. Modifications to ARO liabilities and accumulated accretion occur when lease agreements are amended or when assumptions change, such as the rate of inflation. Modifications are accounted for prospectively as changes in estimates. Settlements occur when leased premises are vacated and the actual cost of restoration is paid. Differences between the actual costs of restoration and the balance recorded as ARO liabilities are recognized as gains or losses in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income.

 

F - 40



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

(17)       ACCUMULATED OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)

 

The following table summarizes Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) for the periods indicated (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Translation Adjustments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign
Currency
Translation
Adjustments

 

Net
Investment
Hedges

 

Cash Flow
Hedges

 

Other

 

Totals

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) at December 31, 2008

 

$

 (12,236)

 

$

 507

 

$

 (21,180)

 

$

 (111)

 

$

 (33,020)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross changes

 

19,613

 

(1,727)

 

47,072

 

-

 

64,958

 

Tax

 

-

 

-

 

(21,425)

 

-

 

(21,425)

 

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

 

19,613

 

(1,727)

 

25,647

 

-

 

43,533

 

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) at December 31, 2009

 

7,377

 

(1,220)

 

4,467

 

(111)

 

10,513

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross changes

 

7,990

 

-

 

4,583

 

(792)

 

11,781

 

Tax

 

-

 

-

 

(1,960)

 

-

 

(1,960)

 

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

 

7,990

 

-

 

2,623

 

(792)

 

9,821

 

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) at December 31, 2010

 

15,367

 

(1,220)

 

7,090

 

(903)

 

20,334

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross changes

 

(12,057)

 

-

 

(21,337)

 

(655)

 

(34,049)

 

Liquidation of foreign subsidiary

 

(154)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(154)

 

Tax

 

-

 

-

 

8,395

 

-

 

8,395

 

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax

 

(12,211)

 

-

 

(12,942)

 

(655)

 

(25,808)

 

Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) at December 31, 2011

 

$

 3,156

 

$

 (1,220)

 

$

 (5,852)

 

$

 (1,558)

 

$

 (5,474)

 

 

(18)       NET INCOME PER SHARE

 

The following table sets forth the computation of basic and diluted net income per share for the periods indicated (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shares used in basic earnings per share calculation

 

56,669

 

60,361

 

62,891

 

Effect of dilutive securities:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Stock options

 

727

 

874

 

814

 

Restricted stock units

 

564

 

557

 

533

 

Performance-based restricted stock units

 

3

 

-

 

-

 

Total effects of dilutive securities

 

1,294

 

1,431

 

1,347

 

Shares used in dilutive earnings per share calculation

 

57,963

 

61,792

 

64,238

 

 

F - 41



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, 0.1 million, 0.1 million and 0.4 million, respectively, of options to purchase shares of common stock were outstanding but not included in the computation of diluted net income per share because the exercise price exceeded the value of the shares and the effect would have been anti-dilutive. For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, restricted stock units of 0.6 million, 1.1 million, and 0.8 million, respectively, were outstanding but not included in the computation of diluted net income per share because the effect would have been anti-dilutive. For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, there were no performance-based restricted stock units outstanding but not included in the computation of diluted net income per share. For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, restricted stock units that vest based on the Company achieving specified operating income performance targets, of 0.1 million, 0.1 million and 0.1 million, respectively, were outstanding but not included in the computation of diluted net income per share because they were not determined to be contingently issuable.

 

(19)       EMPLOYEE COMPENSATION PLANS

 

Employee Benefit Plan

 

The Company has two 401(k) profit-sharing plans that allow participation by U.S. employees who have completed six months of service, as defined, and are 21 years of age or older. Participants may defer up to 75% of their gross pay, up to a maximum limit determined by U.S. federal law. Participants are also eligible for a matching contribution. The Company may from time to time, at its discretion, make a “matching contribution” based on the amount and rate of the elective deferrals. The Company determines how much, if any, it will contribute for each dollar of elective deferrals. Participants vest in matching contributions over a three-year period. Company matching contributions to the 401(k) plans totaled $1.9 million, $2.2 million and $2.7 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

 

Equity Compensation Plans

 

In February 1999, the Company adopted the TeleTech Holdings, Inc. 1999 Stock Option and Incentive Plan (the “1999 Plan”). The purpose of the 1999 Plan was to enable the Company to continue to (a) attract and retain high quality directors, officers, employees, consultants and independent contractors; (b) motivate such persons to promote the long-term success of the Company and its subsidiaries; and (c) induce employees of companies that are acquired by TeleTech to accept employment with TeleTech following such an acquisition. The 1999 Plan supplemented the 1995 Option Plan. An aggregate of 7.0 million shares of common stock were reserved under the 1995 Option Plan and 14.0 million shares of common stock were reserved for issuance under the 1999 Plan, which permitted the award of incentive stock options, non-qualified stock options, stock appreciation rights, shares of restricted common stock and restricted stock units (“RSUs”). The 1999 Plan also provided for annual equity-based compensation grants to members of the Company’s Board of Directors. Options granted to employees generally vested over four to five years and had a contractual life of ten years. Options issued to Directors vested immediately and had a contractual life of ten years. In May of 2009, the Company adopted a policy to issue RSUs to Directors, which generally vest over one year.

 

In May 2010, the Company adopted the 2010 Equity Incentive Plan (the “2010 Plan”). Upon adoption of the 2010 Plan, all authorized and unissued equity in both the 1995 Option Plan and the 1999 Plan was cancelled. An aggregate of 4.0 million shares of common stock has been reserved for issuance under the 2010 Plan, which permits the award of incentive stock options, non-qualified stock options, stock appreciation rights, shares of restricted common stock and restricted stock units. As of December 31, 2011, a total of 4.0 million shares were authorized and 2.9 million shares were available for issuance under the 2010 Plan.

 

F - 42



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009, the Company recorded total equity-based compensation expense under all equity-based arrangements (stock options and RSUs) of $15.9 million, $13.4 million and $11.6 million, respectively. All compensation expense is included in Selling, general and administrative expense in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income. For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009, the Company recognized a tax benefit under all equity-based arrangements (stock options and RSUs) of $11.6 million, $5.2 million and $3.8 million, respectively.

 

Restricted Stock Units

 

2007 RSU Awards:  Beginning in January 2007, the Compensation Committee of the Company’s Board of Directors granted RSUs under the 1999 Plan to certain members of the Company’s management team. RSUs are intended to provide management with additional incentives to promote the success of the Company’s business, thereby aligning their interests with the interests of the Company’s stockholders. One RSU award was granted during 2007 for 500,000 shares and vests equally over a 10-year period. The Company granted an additional RSU award for 500,000 shares of which 50% vests equally over five years and 50% is earned by achieving specific performance targets over a five year period. Of the remaining RSUs granted during 2007, one-third vest over five years based on the individual recipient’s continued employment with the Company (“time vesting RSUs”) and two-thirds vested pro-rata over three years based on the Company achieving specified operating income performance targets in each of the years 2007, 2008, and 2009 (“performance RSUs”). If the performance target for a particular year is not met, the performance RSUs scheduled to vest are canceled. The Company records compensation expense for the performance RSUs when it concludes that it is probable that the performance condition will be achieved. Because the Company did not achieve the operating income performance targets in 2010, the performance RSUs were canceled. There were no performance RSUs outstanding as of December 31, 2011.

 

2009, 2010 and 2011 RSU Awards:  The Company granted RSUs in 2009, 2010 and 2011 to new and existing employees that vest over four years. The Company also granted RSUs in 2010 and 2011 to members of the Board of Directors that generally vest over one year. The Company granted 43,500 performance-based RSUs to eLoyalty employees that vest in equal installments over four years based on eLoyalty achieving specified revenue and operating income performance targets. There were no performance-based RSUs issued in 2009 and 2010. All RSUs vested during the year ended December 31, 2011 were issued out of treasury stock.

 

Summary of RSUs:  Settlement of the RSUs shall be made in shares of the Company’s common stock by delivery of one share of common stock for each RSU then being settled. The Company calculates the fair value for RSUs based on the closing price of the Company’s stock on the date of grant and records compensation expense over the vesting period using a straight-line method. The Company factors an estimated forfeiture rate in calculating compensation expense on RSUs and adjusts for actual forfeitures upon the vesting of each tranche of RSUs.

 

The weighted-average grant date fair value of RSUs, including performance-based RSUs, granted during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009 was $19.49, $17.82, and $9.42 per share, respectively. The total intrinsic value of RSUs vested during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009 was $13.9 million, $10.6 million, and $5.7 million.

 

F - 43



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

A summary of the status of the Company’s non-vested RSUs and performance-based RSUs and activity for the year ended December 31, 2011 is as follows:

 

 

 

Shares

 

Weighted
Average
Grant Date
Fair Value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unvested as of December 31, 2010

 

2,709,202

 

$

 18.45

Granted

 

890,080

 

$

 19.49

Vested

 

(824,259)

 

$

 16.85

Cancellations/expirations

 

(228,151)

 

$

 20.66

 

 

 

 

 

Unvested as of December 31, 2011

 

2,546,872

 

$

 18.48

 

As of December 31, 2011, there was approximately $34.7 million of total unrecognized compensation expense and approximately $42.1 million in total intrinsic value related to non-vested RSU grants. The unrecognized compensation expense will be recognized over the remaining weighted-average vesting period of 1.5 years using the straight-line method.

 

Stock Options

 

During the year ended December 31, 2011, the Company granted 150,000 stock options to a key employee. The stock option award is made up of four separate tranches. Each tranche will vest based on certain stock price targets (market conditions). The grant date fair values of each tranche were calculated using a Monte Carlo simulation model in addition to a time-based binomial lattice model. The following table provides the assumptions used in the time-based binomial lattice model for each tranche granted:

 

 

 

Year Ended December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

2009

 

Risk-free interest rate

 

2.1%

 

-

 

-

 

Expected life in years

 

1.3 - 2.7

 

-

 

-

 

Expected volatility

 

54.4%

 

-

 

-

 

Dividend yield

 

0.0%

 

-

 

-

 

Weighted-average volatility

 

54.4%

 

-

 

-

 

 

The Company estimated the expected term based on historical averages of option exercises and expirations. The calculation of expected volatility is based on the historical volatility of the Company’s common stock over the expected term. The risk-free interest rate is based on the yield on the grant measurement date of a traded zero-coupon U.S. Treasury bond, as reported by the U.S. Federal Reserve, with a term equal to the expected term of the stock option granted. The Company factored an estimated forfeiture rate and adjusted for actual forfeitures upon the vesting of each tranche of options.

 

F - 44



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

A summary of stock option activity for the year ended December 31, 2011 is as follows:

 

 

 

Shares

 

Weighted
Average
Exercise
Price

 

Weighted
Average
Remaining
Contract
Term in Years

 

Aggregate
Intrinsic
Value
(000’s)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2010

 

2,877,620

 

$ 10.82

 

 

 

 

 

Grants

 

150,000

 

$ 17.31

 

 

 

 

 

Exercises

 

(1,564,332)

 

$ 9.43

 

 

 

 

 

Post-vest cancellations/expirations

 

(780)

 

$ 10.98

 

 

 

 

 

Outstanding as of December 31, 2011

 

1,462,508

 

$ 12.98

 

4.4

 

$

 6,092

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Vested and exercisable as of December 31, 2011

 

1,311,508

 

$ 12.48

 

3.8

 

$

 6,092

 

 

The weighted-average grant-date fair value of options granted during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $8.68, $0 and $0 per share, respectively. The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $12.6 million, $2.3 million and $4.0 million, respectively. The total fair value of shares vested during the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $0.1 million, $0.7 million and $2.6 million, respectively.

 

As of December 31, 2011, there was approximately $1.2 million of unrecognized compensation expense related to non-vested stock options. The unrecognized compensation expense will be recognized over the remaining weighted-average derived service period of 2.4 years using the straight-line method. Equity-based compensation expense is recognized in Selling, general and administrative in the accompanying Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income.

 

Cash received from option exercises under the Plans for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $14.8 million, $2.8 million and $6.2 million, respectively. The recognized tax benefit from option exercises for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 was $5.0 million, $1.0 million and $1.6 million, respectively. Shares issued for options exercised during the year ended December 31, 2011 were issued out of treasury stock.

 

(20)       STOCK REPURCHASE PROGRAM

 

Stock Repurchase Program

 

The Company has a stock repurchase program, which was initially authorized by the Company’s Board of Directors in November 2001. As of December 31, 2011, the cumulative authorized repurchase allowance was $462.3 million. During the year ended December 31, 2011, the Company purchased 3.4 million shares for $63.7 million. Since inception of the program, the Company has purchased 32.2 million shares for $430.6 million. As of December 31, 2011, the remaining allowance under the program was approximately $31.7 million. For the period from January 1, 2012 through February 23, 2012, the Company has purchased an additional 0.2 million shares for $2.4 million. The stock repurchase program does not have an expiration date.

 

(21)       RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

 

The Company has entered into an agreement under which Avion, LLC (“Avion”) provides certain aviation flight services as requested by the Company. Such services include the use of an aircraft and flight crew. Kenneth D. Tuchman, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of the Company, has a direct 100% beneficial ownership interest in Avion. During 2011, 2010 and 2009, the Company paid $1.5 million, $1.5 million and $0.6 million, respectively, to Avion for services provided to the Company. There were no amounts outstanding to Avion as of December 31, 2011.

 

F - 45



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

During 2011, the Company contracted for consulting services with Lender Live, a company owned by a member of the Board of Directors of the Company. During 2011, the Company accrued $0.2 million for services provided to the Company by Lender Live, for which the payment was made in 2012.

 

The Audit Committee of the Board of Directors reviews these transactions annually and has determined that the fees charged by these related parties are at fair market value.

 

(22)       OTHER FINANCIAL INFORMATION

 

Self-insurance liabilities of the Company which are included in Accrued employee compensation and benefits and Other accrued expenses in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets were as follows (amounts in thousands):

 

 

 

December 31,

 

 

 

2011

 

2010

 

Worker’s compensation

 

$

 2,507

 

$

 2,720

 

Employee health and dental insurance

 

3,324

 

2,912

 

Other general liability insurance

 

1,225

 

1,221

 

Total self-insurance liabilities

 

$

 7,056

 

$

 6,853

 

 

(23)       DECONSOLIDATION OF A SUBSIDIARY

 

On December 22, 2008, Newgen Results Corporation (“Newgen”), a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, filed a voluntary petition for liquidation under Chapter 7 in the United States Bankruptcy Court for the District of Delaware. The consolidation of a majority-owned subsidiary is precluded where control does not rest with the majority owners and under legal reorganization or bankruptcy control rests with the Bankruptcy Court. Accordingly, the Company deconsolidated Newgen as of December 22, 2008.

 

On September 9, 2010, Newgen settled a legal claim for $3.6 million that was paid for by the Company on behalf of Newgen. As a result of the legal settlement, the Company recognized a $5.9 million gain in Other income (expense), net and a $2.3 million expense in Provision for income taxes for the year 2010. As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Company’s negative investment in Newgen was $0.1 million as presented in the accompanying Consolidated Balance Sheets.

 

The following condensed financial statements of Newgen have been prepared to show the remaining liabilities subject to compromise by the Bankruptcy Court to be reported separately from the liabilities not subject to compromise (pre and post rent settlement). All liabilities included in the condensed financial statements below are subject to compromise as of December 31, 2011 and represent the current estimate of the amount of known or potential pre-petition claims that are subject to final settlement. Such claims remain subject to future adjustments.

 

 

 

December 31,
2011

 

December 31,
2010

 

December 31,
2009

 

Total current assets

 

$

 127

 

$

 127

 

$

 1,700

 

Total long-term assets

 

-

 

-

 

2,379

 

Total assets

 

$

 127

 

$

 127

 

$

 4,079

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total current liabilities

 

$

 203

 

$

 203

 

$

 7,886

 

Total liabilities

 

203

 

203

 

7,886

 

Total stockholders’ deficit

 

(76)

 

(76)

 

(3,807)

 

Total liabilities and stockholders’ deficit

 

$

 127

 

$

 127

 

$

 4,079

 

 

F - 46



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

(24)       QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED)

 

The following tables present certain quarterly financial data for the year ended December 31, 2011 (amounts in thousands except per share amounts).

 

 

 

First
Quarter

 

Second
Quarter

 

Third
Quarter

 

Fourth
Quarter

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue

 

$

 280,979

 

$

 293,636

 

$

 304,235

 

$

 300,538

 

Cost of services

 

199,121

 

210,358

 

220,795

 

218,088

 

Selling, general and administrative

 

47,801

 

47,283

 

43,445

 

50,273

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

11,598

 

11,423

 

11,807

 

10,061

 

Restructuring charges, net

 

739

 

(57)

 

1,616

 

1,353

 

Impairment losses

 

230

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Income from operations

 

21,490

 

24,629

 

26,572

 

20,763

 

Other income (expense)

 

(270)

 

(1,276)

 

(633)

 

279

 

(Provision) benefit for income taxes

 

(9,849)

 

(129)

 

496

 

(3,797)

 

Non-controlling interest

 

(898)

 

(1,007)

 

(1,064)

 

(1,132)

 

Net income attributable to TeleTech stockholders

 

$

 10,473

 

$

 22,217

 

$

 25,371

 

$

 16,113

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

57,190

 

56,713

 

56,476

 

56,309

 

Diluted

 

58,797

 

57,974

 

57,748

 

57,500

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income per share attributable to TeleTech stockholders

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

 0.18

 

$

 0.39

 

$

 0.45

 

$

 0.29

 

Diluted

 

$

 0.18

 

$

 0.38

 

$

 0.44

 

$

 0.28

 

 

Included in Cost of services and selling, general and administrative expenses in the third quarter is a $2.8 million reduction for variable incentive compensation.

 

Included in the Provision for Income Taxes for the first and fourth quarter is an increase of $9.0 million and a decrease of $0.4 million respectively related to the adverse decision by the Canadian Revenue Agency (“CRA”) in regards to the Company’s attempt to recover taxes paid to Canada with respect to the years 2001 and 2002.  Also included in the Provision for income taxes in the first, second and third quarter is a reduction in expense related to the mediated settlement reached with the IRS concerning tax refund claims of $2.9 million, $5.7 million and $3.0 million respectively.  Also included in the third quarter is a $1.4 million benefit related to the Company’s 2010 foreign earnings repatriation.

 

F - 47



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

The following tables present certain quarterly financial data for the year ended December 31, 2010 (amounts in thousands except per share amounts).

 

 

 

First
Quarter

 

Second
Quarter

 

Third
Quarter

 

Fourth
Quarter

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revenue

 

$

 271,526

 

$

 271,927

 

$

 271,005

 

$

 280,448

 

Cost of services

 

194,618

 

198,194

 

193,996

 

202,889

 

Selling, general and administrative

 

43,408

 

39,741

 

40,572

 

42,091

 

Depreciation and amortization

 

12,724

 

12,946

 

12,452

 

12,096

 

Restructuring charges, net

 

1,469

 

1,304

 

3,579

 

7,124

 

Impairment losses

 

-

 

679

 

327

 

952

 

Income from operations

 

19,307

 

19,063

 

20,079

 

15,296

 

Other income (expense)

 

(211)

 

332

 

7,295

 

808

 

Provision for income taxes

 

(5,054)

 

(5,071)

 

(7,586)

 

(10,720)

 

Non-controlling interest

 

(755)

 

(922)

 

(1,118)

 

(869)

 

Net income attributable to TeleTech stockholders

 

$

 13,287

 

$

 13,402

 

$

 18,670

 

$

 4,515

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Weighted average shares outstanding

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

61,877

 

61,117

 

59,808

 

58,690

 

Diluted

 

63,483

 

62,317

 

61,028

 

60,369

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income per share attributable to TeleTech stockholders

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

$

 0.21

 

$

 0.22

 

$

 0.31

 

$

 0.08

 

Diluted

 

$

 0.21

 

$

 0.22

 

$

 0.31

 

$

 0.07

 

 

Included in Revenue for the first quarter is a $2.0 million reduction for disputed service delivery issues which occurred in 2009.

 

Included in Selling, general and administrative for the second and fourth quarters, respectively, is a decrease of $0.3 million and $1.1 million due to change in estimates relating to self-insurance liabilities.

 

Included in Other income (expense) for the third quarter is a $5.9 million gain related to the settlement of a Newgen legal claim.

 

Included in Provision for income taxes for the third quarter is a $2.3 million expense related to the gain described above.

 

Included in the Provision for income taxes for the fourth quarter is a $5.6 million expense related repatriation of foreign earnings previously considered permanently invested outside the U.S., an increase of $2.5 million in the U.S. deferred tax liability related to foreign tax assets that can no longer offset taxable income in more than one jurisdiction, an increase of $6.6 million in the deferred tax valuation allowance of which $3.7 million is related to certain European markets, and a $2.3 million expense related to our legal settlement included in Other income (expense) and $0.7 million in other items, offset by a $4.0 million benefit related to foreign tax planning strategies associated with the International operations.

 

F - 48



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

EXHIBIT INDEX

 

Exhibit No.

 

Description

  3.01

 

Restated Certificate of Incorporation of TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to TeleTech’s Amendment No. 2 to Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-04097) filed on July 5, 1996)

  3.02

 

Second Amended and Restated Bylaws of TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.02 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on May 28, 2009)

10.01

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Stock Plan, as amended and restated (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to TeleTech’s Amendment No. 2 to Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-04097) filed on July 5, 1996)**

10.02

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Amended and Restated Employee Stock Purchase Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to TeleTech’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-113432) filed on March 9, 2004)**

10.03

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Directors Stock Option Plan, as amended and restated (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 to TeleTech’s Amendment No. 2 to Form S-1 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-04097) filed on July 5, 1996)**

10.04

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Amended and Restated 1999 Stock Option and Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to TeleTech’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-96617) filed on July 17, 2002)**

10.05

 

Amendment to 1999 Stock Option and Incentive Plan dated February 11, 2009 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.05 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

10.06

 

TeleTech Holdings, Inc. 2010 Equity Incentive Plan (incorporated by reference to Appendix A to TeleTech’s Definitive Proxy Statement, filed April 12, 2010)**

10.07

 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (effective in 2007 and 2008) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.05 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)**

10.08

 

Amendment to Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (effective December 2008) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.07 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

10.09

 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (effective in 2009) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 17, 2009)**

10.10

 

Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (below Vice President) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.06 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)**

10.11

 

Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (Vice President and above) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.07 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)**

10.12

 

Form of Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement (Non-Employee Director) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.08 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2007)**

10.13

 

Independent Director Compensation Arrangements (effective May 21, 2009) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended June 30, 2009)**

10.14

 

Employment Agreement between James E. Barlett and TeleTech dated October 15, 2001 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.66 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001)**

10.15

 

Amendment to Employment Agreement between James E. Barlett and TeleTech dated December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

 



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Exhibit No.

 

Description

10.16

 

Stock Option Agreement dated October 15, 2001 between James E. Barlett and TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.70 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001)**

10.17

 

Amendment dated September 17, 2008 to Stock Option Agreement between James E. Barlett and TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

10.18

 

Employment Agreement between Kenneth D. Tuchman and TeleTech dated October 15, 2001 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.68 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2001)**

10.19

 

Amendment to Employment Agreement between Kenneth D. Tuchman and TeleTech dated December 31, 2008 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.17 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

10.20

 

Amendment dated September 17, 2008 to Stock Option Agreement between Kenneth D. Tuchman and TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to TeleTech’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2008)**

10.21

 

Credit Agreement, dated as of October 1, 2010, among TeleTech Holdings, Inc., the lenders party thereto, KeyBank National Association, as Joint Lead Arranger, Sole Book Runner and Administrative Agent, Wells Fargo Bank, National Association, as Joint Lead Arranger and Co-Syndication Agent, Bank of America, N.A., as Co-Syndication Agent, BBVA Compass, as Co-Documentation Agent and JPMorgan Chase Bank, N.A., as Co-Documentation Agent (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on October 7, 2010)

10.22

 

Form of Indemnification Agreement with Directors (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 17, 2010)**

10.23

 

Form of Amendment to Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 17, 2010)**

10.24

 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed on February 17, 2010)**

10.25

 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (Section 16 Officers) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to TeleTech’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-167300) filed on June 3, 2010)**

10.26

 

Form of Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (Non-Section 16 Employees) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to TeleTech’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-167300) filed on June 3, 2010)**

10.27

 

Form of Independent Director Restricted Stock Unit Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.5 to TeleTech’s Form S-8 Registration Statement (Registration No. 333-167300) filed on June 3, 2010)**

10.28

 

Executive Employment Agreement dated March 8, 2010 between Joseph Bellini and TeleTech (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended March 31, 2010)**

10.29

 

First Amendment to Executive Employment Agreement, dated September 20, 2010 between TeleTech and Joseph Bellini (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended September 30, 2010)**

10.30

 

Second Amendment, dated as of April 19, 2011, to TeleTech Holdings, Inc. Restricted Stock Unit Agreement by and between TeleTech Holdings, Inc. and James E. Barlett dated June 22, 2007 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed April 22, 2011)**

10.31

 

Employment Agreement between Regina Paolillo and TeleTech Holdings, Inc. effective as of November 3, 2011 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed October 27, 2011)**

10.32

 

Restricted Stock Unit Agreement dated as of November 15, 2011 between TeleTech Holdings, Inc. and Regina Paolillo (RSU Agreement) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K/A filed November 21, 2011)**

10.33

 

Restricted Stock Unit Agreement dated as of November 15, 2011 between TeleTech Holdings, Inc. and Regina Paolillo (RSU Performance Agreement) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K/A filed November 21, 2011)**

10.34

 

Non-Qualified Stock Option Agreement dated as of November 15, 2011 between TeleTech Holdings, Inc. and Regina Paolillo (Option Agreement) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K/A filed November 21, 2011)**

10.35

 

General Release Agreement between Carol Kline and TeleTech Holdings, Inc. effective as of January 26, 2012 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to TeleTech’s Current Report on Form 8-K filed January 31, 2012)**

21.01*

 

List of subsidiaries

23.01*

 

Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

31.01*

 

Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of CEO of TeleTech

31.02*

 

Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of CFO of TeleTech

32.01*

 

Written Statement of Chief Executive Officer Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (18 U.S.C. Section 1350)

 



 

TELETECH HOLDINGS, INC. AND SUBSIDIARIES

Notes to the Consolidated Financial Statements

 

Exhibit No.

 

Description

32.02*

 

Written Statement of Acting Chief Financial Officer Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 (18 U.S.C. Section 1350)

101.INS***

 

XBRL Instance Document

101.SCH***

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document

101.CAL***

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document.

101.LAB***

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document

101.PRE***

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document

101.DEF***

 

XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document

 


 

*

Filed herewith.

**

Identifies exhibit that consists of or includes a management contract or compensatory plan or arrangement.

***

Attached as Exhibit 101 to this report are the following documents formatted in XBRL (Extensible Business Reporting Language): (i) Consolidated Statements of Operations and Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, (ii) Consolidated Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, (iii) Consolidated Statements of Stockholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, (iv) Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, and (v) Notes to Consolidated Financial Statements. Users of this data are advised pursuant to Rule 406T of Regulation S-T that this interactive data file is deemed not filed or part of a registration statement or prospectus for purposes of sections 11 or 12 of the Securities Act of 1933, is deemed not filed for purposes of section 18 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, and otherwise is not subject to liability under these sections.